]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - src/xterm.c
Simplify last change.
[gnu-emacs] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
3 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009
4 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5
6 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7
8 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
9 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
10 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
11 (at your option) any later version.
12
13 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
14 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
15 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
16 GNU General Public License for more details.
17
18 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
19 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20
21 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
22 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
23
24 #include <config.h>
25
26 /* On 4.3 these lose if they come after xterm.h. */
27 /* Putting these at the beginning seems to be standard for other .c files. */
28 #include <signal.h>
29
30 #include <stdio.h>
31
32 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
33
34 #include "lisp.h"
35 #include "blockinput.h"
36
37 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
38 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
39 #include "syssignal.h"
40
41 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
42 if this is not done before the other system files. */
43 #include "xterm.h"
44 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
45
46 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
47 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
48 #ifndef makedev
49 #include <sys/types.h>
50 #endif /* makedev */
51
52 #ifdef BSD_SYSTEM
53 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
54 #endif /* ! defined (BSD_SYSTEM) */
55
56 #include "systime.h"
57
58 #ifndef INCLUDED_FCNTL
59 #include <fcntl.h>
60 #endif
61 #include <ctype.h>
62 #include <errno.h>
63 #include <setjmp.h>
64 #include <sys/stat.h>
65 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
66 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
67
68 #include "charset.h"
69 #include "character.h"
70 #include "coding.h"
71 #include "frame.h"
72 #include "dispextern.h"
73 #include "fontset.h"
74 #include "termhooks.h"
75 #include "termopts.h"
76 #include "termchar.h"
77 #include "emacs-icon.h"
78 #include "disptab.h"
79 #include "buffer.h"
80 #include "window.h"
81 #include "keyboard.h"
82 #include "intervals.h"
83 #include "process.h"
84 #include "atimer.h"
85 #include "keymap.h"
86 #include "font.h"
87 #include "fontset.h"
88
89 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
90 #include <X11/Shell.h>
91 #endif
92
93 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
94 #include <sys/time.h>
95 #endif
96 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
97 #include <unistd.h>
98 #endif
99
100 #ifdef USE_GTK
101 #include "gtkutil.h"
102 #endif
103
104 #ifdef USE_LUCID
105 extern int xlwmenu_window_p P_ ((Widget w, Window window));
106 extern void xlwmenu_redisplay P_ ((Widget));
107 #endif
108
109 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
110
111 extern void free_frame_menubar P_ ((struct frame *));
112 extern struct frame *x_menubar_window_to_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
113 int));
114 #endif
115
116 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
117 #if (XtSpecificationRelease >= 5) && !defined(NO_EDITRES)
118 #define HACK_EDITRES
119 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
120 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
121
122 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
123
124 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
125 #if defined USE_MOTIF
126 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
127 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
128 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
129
130 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
131 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
132 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
133 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
134 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
135 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
136 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
137 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
138 #ifndef XtNpickTop
139 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
140 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
141 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
142 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
143
144 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
145
146 #if ! defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) && ! defined (USE_GTK)
147 #define x_any_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
148 #define x_top_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
149 #endif
150
151 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
152 #include "widget.h"
153 #ifndef XtNinitialState
154 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
155 #endif
156 #endif
157
158 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
159 #ifdef USE_XIM
160 int use_xim = 1;
161 #else
162 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
163 #endif
164
165 \f
166
167 /* Non-nil means Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars. */
168
169 Lisp_Object Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars;
170
171 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
172 start. */
173
174 static int any_help_event_p;
175
176 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
177 static Lisp_Object last_window;
178
179 /* Non-zero means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties. */
180
181 int x_use_underline_position_properties;
182
183 /* Non-zero means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line. */
184
185 int x_underline_at_descent_line;
186
187 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
188 use. */
189
190 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
191
192 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
193 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
194 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
195 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
196
197 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
198
199 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
200 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
201 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
202 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
203
204 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
205
206 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
207
208 struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
209
210 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
211 /* The application context for Xt use. */
212 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
213 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
214 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
215
216 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
217
218 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
219
220 /* Non-zero means to not move point as a result of clicking on a
221 frame to focus it (when focus-follows-mouse is nil). */
222
223 int x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position;
224
225 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
226 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
227 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
228
229 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
230
231 /* Mouse movement.
232
233 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
234 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
235 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
236 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
237
238 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
239
240 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
241 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
242 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
243 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
244 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
245 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
246 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
247 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
248 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
249 is off. */
250
251 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
252
253 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
254 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
255 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
256
257 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
258
259 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
260 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
261 an ordinary motion.
262
263 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
264 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
265 event. */
266
267 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
268
269 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
270 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
271 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
272 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
273 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
274 it's somewhat accurate. */
275
276 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
277
278 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
279
280 static Time last_user_time;
281
282 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
283 events. */
284
285 #ifdef __STDC__
286 static int volatile input_signal_count;
287 #else
288 static int input_signal_count;
289 #endif
290
291 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
292
293 static int x_noop_count;
294
295 /* Initial values of argv and argc. */
296
297 extern char **initial_argv;
298 extern int initial_argc;
299
300 extern Lisp_Object Vcommand_line_args, Vsystem_name;
301
302 /* Tells if a window manager is present or not. */
303
304 extern Lisp_Object Vx_no_window_manager;
305
306 extern Lisp_Object Qeql;
307
308 extern int errno;
309
310 /* A mask of extra modifier bits to put into every keyboard char. */
311
312 extern EMACS_INT extra_keyboard_modifiers;
313
314 /* The keysyms to use for the various modifiers. */
315
316 Lisp_Object Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym, Vx_super_keysym;
317 Lisp_Object Vx_keysym_table;
318 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
319
320 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
321 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
322
323 #ifdef USE_GTK
324 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
325 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
326 #endif
327
328 /* Used in x_flush. */
329
330 extern Lisp_Object Vinhibit_redisplay;
331
332 extern XrmDatabase x_load_resources P_ ((Display *, char *, char *, char *));
333 extern int x_bitmap_mask P_ ((FRAME_PTR, int));
334
335 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 P_ ((Display *, Colormap, XColor *));
336 static void x_set_window_size_1 P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
337 static const XColor *x_color_cells P_ ((Display *, int *));
338 static void x_update_window_end P_ ((struct window *, int, int));
339
340 static int x_io_error_quitter P_ ((Display *));
341 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
342 void x_delete_terminal P_ ((struct terminal *));
343 static void x_update_end P_ ((struct frame *));
344 static void XTframe_up_to_date P_ ((struct frame *));
345 static void XTset_terminal_modes P_ ((struct terminal *));
346 static void XTreset_terminal_modes P_ ((struct terminal *));
347 static void x_clear_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
348 static void frame_highlight P_ ((struct frame *));
349 static void frame_unhighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
350 static void x_new_focus_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *, struct frame *));
351 static void x_focus_changed P_ ((int, int, struct x_display_info *,
352 struct frame *, struct input_event *));
353 static void x_detect_focus_change P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
354 XEvent *, struct input_event *));
355 static void XTframe_rehighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
356 static void x_frame_rehighlight P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
357 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *));
358 static void x_draw_bar_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
359 enum text_cursor_kinds));
360
361 static void x_clip_to_row P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC));
362 static void x_flush P_ ((struct frame *f));
363 static void x_update_begin P_ ((struct frame *));
364 static void x_update_window_begin P_ ((struct window *));
365 static void x_after_update_window_line P_ ((struct glyph_row *));
366 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar P_ ((Display *, Window));
367 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion P_ ((struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
368 enum scroll_bar_part *,
369 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
370 unsigned long *));
371 static void x_handle_net_wm_state P_ ((struct frame *, XPropertyEvent *));
372 static void x_check_fullscreen P_ ((struct frame *));
373 static void x_check_expected_move P_ ((struct frame *, int, int));
374 static void x_sync_with_move P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
375 static int handle_one_xevent P_ ((struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
376 int *, struct input_event *));
377 /* Don't declare this NO_RETURN because we want no
378 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
379 static SIGTYPE x_connection_closed P_ ((Display *, char *));
380
381
382 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
383
384 static void
385 x_flush (f)
386 struct frame *f;
387 {
388 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
389 connection may be broken. */
390 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
391 return;
392
393 BLOCK_INPUT;
394 if (f == NULL)
395 {
396 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
397 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
398 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
399 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
400 }
401 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
402 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
403 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
404 }
405
406
407 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
408 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
409 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
410 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
411 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
412 performance. */
413
414 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
415
416 \f
417 /***********************************************************************
418 Debugging
419 ***********************************************************************/
420
421 #if 0
422
423 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
424 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
425
426 struct record
427 {
428 char *locus;
429 int type;
430 };
431
432 struct record event_record[100];
433
434 int event_record_index;
435
436 record_event (locus, type)
437 char *locus;
438 int type;
439 {
440 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
441 event_record_index = 0;
442
443 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
444 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
445 event_record_index++;
446 }
447
448 #endif /* 0 */
449
450
451 \f
452 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
453
454 struct x_display_info *
455 x_display_info_for_display (dpy)
456 Display *dpy;
457 {
458 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
459
460 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
461 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
462 return dpyinfo;
463
464 return 0;
465 }
466
467 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
468 #define OPACITY "_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY"
469
470 void
471 x_set_frame_alpha (f)
472 struct frame *f;
473 {
474 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
475 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
476 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
477 double alpha = 1.0;
478 double alpha_min = 1.0;
479 unsigned long opac;
480
481 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window != FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc)
482 /* Since the WM decoration lies under the FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW,
483 we must treat the former instead of the latter. */
484 win = FRAME_X_OUTPUT(f)->parent_desc;
485
486 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
487 alpha = f->alpha[0];
488 else
489 alpha = f->alpha[1];
490
491 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
492 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
493 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
494 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
495
496 if (alpha < 0.0)
497 return;
498 else if (alpha > 1.0)
499 alpha = 1.0;
500 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
501 alpha = alpha_min;
502
503 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
504
505 /* return unless necessary */
506 {
507 unsigned char *data;
508 Atom actual;
509 int rc, format;
510 unsigned long n, left;
511
512 x_catch_errors (dpy);
513 rc = XGetWindowProperty(dpy, win, XInternAtom(dpy, OPACITY, False),
514 0L, 1L, False, XA_CARDINAL,
515 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
516 &data);
517
518 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
519 if (*(unsigned long *)data == opac)
520 {
521 XFree ((void *) data);
522 x_uncatch_errors ();
523 return;
524 }
525 else
526 XFree ((void *) data);
527 x_uncatch_errors ();
528 }
529
530 x_catch_errors (dpy);
531 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, XInternAtom (dpy, OPACITY, False),
532 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
533 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
534 x_uncatch_errors ();
535 }
536
537 int
538 x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo)
539 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
540 {
541 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
542 }
543
544 int
545 x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo)
546 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
547 {
548 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
549 }
550
551 \f
552 /***********************************************************************
553 Starting and ending an update
554 ***********************************************************************/
555
556 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
557 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
558 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
559 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
560 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
561
562 static void
563 x_update_begin (f)
564 struct frame *f;
565 {
566 /* Nothing to do. */
567 }
568
569
570 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
571 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
572 position of W. */
573
574 static void
575 x_update_window_begin (w)
576 struct window *w;
577 {
578 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
579 struct x_display_info *display_info = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
580
581 updated_window = w;
582 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
583
584 BLOCK_INPUT;
585
586 if (f == display_info->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
587 {
588 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
589 display_info->mouse_face_defer = 1;
590
591 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
592 highlighting. */
593 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
594 display_info->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
595 }
596
597 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
598 }
599
600
601 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
602
603 static void
604 x_draw_vertical_window_border (w, x, y0, y1)
605 struct window *w;
606 int x, y0, y1;
607 {
608 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
609 struct face *face;
610
611 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
612 if (face)
613 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
614 face->foreground);
615
616 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
617 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
618 }
619
620 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
621
622 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
623 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
624
625 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
626 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
627 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
628
629 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
630 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
631 here. */
632
633 static void
634 x_update_window_end (w, cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p)
635 struct window *w;
636 int cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p;
637 {
638 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
639
640 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
641 {
642 BLOCK_INPUT;
643
644 if (cursor_on_p)
645 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
646 output_cursor.vpos,
647 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
648
649 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
650 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
651
652 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
653 }
654
655 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
656 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
657 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
658 {
659 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
660 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
661 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
662 }
663
664 updated_window = NULL;
665 }
666
667
668 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
669 update_end. */
670
671 static void
672 x_update_end (f)
673 struct frame *f;
674 {
675 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
676 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
677
678 #ifndef XFlush
679 BLOCK_INPUT;
680 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
681 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
682 #endif
683 }
684
685
686 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
687 complete update has been performed. The global variable
688 updated_window is not available here. */
689
690 static void
691 XTframe_up_to_date (f)
692 struct frame *f;
693 {
694 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
695 {
696 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
697
698 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
699 || f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
700 {
701 BLOCK_INPUT;
702 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
703 note_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
704 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
705 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
706 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
707 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
708 }
709 }
710 }
711
712
713 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
714 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
715 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
716 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
717 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
718 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
719
720 static void
721 x_after_update_window_line (desired_row)
722 struct glyph_row *desired_row;
723 {
724 struct window *w = updated_window;
725 struct frame *f;
726 int width, height;
727
728 xassert (w);
729
730 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
731 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
732
733 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
734 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
735 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
736 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
737 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
738 overhead is very small. */
739 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
740 && desired_row->full_width_p
741 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
742 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
743 width != 0)
744 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
745 height > 0))
746 {
747 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
748
749 /* Internal border is drawn below the tool bar. */
750 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
751 && w == XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window))
752 y -= width;
753
754 BLOCK_INPUT;
755 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
756 0, y, width, height, False);
757 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
758 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
759 y, width, height, False);
760 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
761 }
762 }
763
764 static void
765 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, p)
766 struct window *w;
767 struct glyph_row *row;
768 struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p;
769 {
770 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
771 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
772 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
773 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
774 struct face *face = p->face;
775 int rowY;
776
777 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
778 rowY = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
779 if (p->y < rowY)
780 {
781 /* Adjust position of "bottom aligned" bitmap on partially
782 visible last row. */
783 int oldY = row->y;
784 int oldVH = row->visible_height;
785 row->visible_height = p->h;
786 row->y -= rowY - p->y;
787 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
788 row->y = oldY;
789 row->visible_height = oldVH;
790 }
791 else
792 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
793
794 if (!p->overlay_p)
795 {
796 int bx = p->bx, by = p->by, nx = p->nx, ny = p->ny;
797
798 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
799 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
800 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
801 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
802 if (face->stipple)
803 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
804 else
805 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
806
807 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
808 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
809 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
810 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
811 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
812 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
813 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
814 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
815 {
816 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
817
818 if (sb_width > 0)
819 {
820 int left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
821 int width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
822 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
823
824 if (bx < 0)
825 {
826 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
827 if (left + width == p->x)
828 bx = left + sb_width;
829 else if (p->x + p->wd == left)
830 bx = left;
831 if (bx >= 0)
832 {
833 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
834
835 nx = width - sb_width;
836 by = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
837 row->y));
838 ny = row->visible_height;
839 }
840 }
841 else
842 {
843 if (left + width == bx)
844 {
845 bx = left + sb_width;
846 nx += width - sb_width;
847 }
848 else if (bx + nx == left)
849 nx += width - sb_width;
850 }
851 }
852 }
853 #endif
854 if (bx >= 0 && nx > 0)
855 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc, bx, by, nx, ny);
856
857 if (!face->stipple)
858 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
859 }
860
861 if (p->which)
862 {
863 unsigned char *bits;
864 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
865 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
866 XGCValues gcv;
867
868 if (p->wd > 8)
869 bits = (unsigned char *)(p->bits + p->dh);
870 else
871 bits = (unsigned char *)p->bits + p->dh;
872
873 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
874 by the server. */
875 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
876 (p->cursor_p
877 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
878 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
879 : face->foreground),
880 face->background, depth);
881
882 if (p->overlay_p)
883 {
884 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
885 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
886 bits, p->wd, p->h,
887 1, 0, 1);
888 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
889 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
890 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
891 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
892 }
893
894 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
895 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
896 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
897
898 if (p->overlay_p)
899 {
900 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
901 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
902 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
903 }
904 }
905
906 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
907 }
908
909 \f
910
911 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
912 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
913 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
914 rarely happens). */
915
916 static void
917 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
918 {
919 }
920
921 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
922 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
923
924 static void
925 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
926 {
927 }
928
929 \f
930 /***********************************************************************
931 Glyph display
932 ***********************************************************************/
933
934
935
936 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
937 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
938 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
939 int));
940 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
941 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
942 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
943 static void x_draw_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
944 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
945 static void x_set_cursor_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
946 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
947 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
948 static int x_alloc_lighter_color P_ ((struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
949 unsigned long *, double, int));
950 static void x_setup_relief_color P_ ((struct frame *, struct relief *,
951 double, int, unsigned long));
952 static void x_setup_relief_colors P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
953 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
954 static void x_draw_image_relief P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
955 static void x_draw_image_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
956 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 P_ ((struct glyph_string *, Pixmap));
957 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int,
958 int, int, int));
959 static void x_draw_relief_rect P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
960 int, int, int, int, int, int,
961 XRectangle *));
962 static void x_draw_box_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
963 int, int, int, XRectangle *));
964
965 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
966 static void x_check_font P_ ((struct frame *, struct font *));
967 #endif
968
969
970 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
971 face. */
972
973 static void
974 x_set_cursor_gc (s)
975 struct glyph_string *s;
976 {
977 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
978 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
979 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
980 && !s->cmp)
981 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
982 else
983 {
984 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
985 XGCValues xgcv;
986 unsigned long mask;
987
988 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
989 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
990
991 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
992 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
993 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
994 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
995 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
996 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
997 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
998
999 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
1000 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
1001 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
1002 {
1003 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
1004 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1005 }
1006
1007 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1008 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1009 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
1010
1011 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1012 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1013 mask, &xgcv);
1014 else
1015 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1016 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1017
1018 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1019 }
1020 }
1021
1022
1023 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
1024
1025 static void
1026 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s)
1027 struct glyph_string *s;
1028 {
1029 int face_id;
1030 struct face *face;
1031
1032 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
1033 face_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
1034 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1035 if (face == NULL)
1036 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
1037
1038 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1039 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
1040 else
1041 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
1042 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1043 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1044
1045 if (s->font == s->face->font)
1046 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1047 else
1048 {
1049 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1050 except for FONT. */
1051 XGCValues xgcv;
1052 unsigned long mask;
1053
1054 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1055 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1056 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1057 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
1058
1059 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1060 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1061 mask, &xgcv);
1062 else
1063 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1064 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1065
1066 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1067
1068 }
1069 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1070 }
1071
1072
1073 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1074 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1075 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1076
1077 static INLINE void
1078 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s)
1079 struct glyph_string *s;
1080 {
1081 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1082 }
1083
1084
1085 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1086 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1087 pattern. */
1088
1089 static INLINE void
1090 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s)
1091 struct glyph_string *s;
1092 {
1093 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1094
1095 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1096 {
1097 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1098 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1099 }
1100 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1101 {
1102 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1103 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1104 }
1105 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1106 {
1107 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1108 s->stippled_p = 0;
1109 }
1110 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1111 {
1112 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1113 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1114 }
1115 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1116 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1117 {
1118 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1119 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1120 }
1121 else
1122 {
1123 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1124 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1125 }
1126
1127 /* GC must have been set. */
1128 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1129 }
1130
1131
1132 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1133 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1134
1135 static INLINE void
1136 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s)
1137 struct glyph_string *s;
1138 {
1139 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1140 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1141
1142 if (n > 0)
1143 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
1144 s->num_clips = n;
1145 }
1146
1147
1148 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1149 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1150 the area of SRC. */
1151
1152 static void
1153 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (src, dst)
1154 struct glyph_string *src, *dst;
1155 {
1156 XRectangle r;
1157
1158 r.x = src->x;
1159 r.width = src->width;
1160 r.y = src->y;
1161 r.height = src->height;
1162 dst->clip[0] = r;
1163 dst->num_clips = 1;
1164 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1165 }
1166
1167
1168 /* RIF:
1169 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1170
1171 static void
1172 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s)
1173 struct glyph_string *s;
1174 {
1175 if (s->cmp == NULL
1176 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1177 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1178 {
1179 struct font_metrics metrics;
1180
1181 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1182 {
1183 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1184 struct font *font = s->font;
1185 int i;
1186
1187 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1188 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1189 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1190 }
1191 else
1192 {
1193 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1194
1195 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1196 }
1197 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1198 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1199 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1200 }
1201 else if (s->cmp)
1202 {
1203 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1204 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1205 }
1206 }
1207
1208
1209 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1210
1211 static INLINE void
1212 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
1213 struct glyph_string *s;
1214 int x, y, w, h;
1215 {
1216 XGCValues xgcv;
1217 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1218 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1219 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1220 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1221 }
1222
1223
1224 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1225 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1226 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1227 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1228 contains the first component of a composition. */
1229
1230 static void
1231 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, force_p)
1232 struct glyph_string *s;
1233 int force_p;
1234 {
1235 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1236 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1237 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1238 {
1239 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1240
1241 if (s->stippled_p)
1242 {
1243 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1244 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1245 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1246 s->y + box_line_width,
1247 s->background_width,
1248 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1249 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1250 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1251 }
1252 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1253 || s->font_not_found_p
1254 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1255 || force_p)
1256 {
1257 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1258 s->background_width,
1259 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1260 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1261 }
1262 }
1263 }
1264
1265
1266 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1267
1268 static void
1269 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1270 struct glyph_string *s;
1271 {
1272 int i, x;
1273
1274 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1275 of S to the right of that box line. */
1276 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1277 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1278 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1279 else
1280 x = s->x;
1281
1282 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1283 loaded. */
1284 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1285 {
1286 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1287 {
1288 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1289 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1290 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1291 s->height - 1);
1292 x += g->pixel_width;
1293 }
1294 }
1295 else
1296 {
1297 struct font *font = s->font;
1298 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1299 int y;
1300
1301 if (font->vertical_centering)
1302 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1303
1304 y = s->ybase - boff;
1305 if (s->for_overlaps
1306 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1307 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1308 else
1309 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1310 if (s->face->overstrike)
1311 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1312 }
1313 }
1314
1315 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1316
1317 static void
1318 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1319 struct glyph_string *s;
1320 {
1321 int i, j, x;
1322 struct font *font = s->font;
1323
1324 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1325 of S to the right of that box line. */
1326 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1327 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1328 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1329 else
1330 x = s->x;
1331
1332 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1333 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1334 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1335 this composition. */
1336
1337 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1338 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1339 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1340 {
1341 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1342 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1343 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1344 }
1345 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1346 {
1347 int y = s->ybase;
1348
1349 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1350 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1351 {
1352 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1353 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1354
1355 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1356 if (s->face->overstrike)
1357 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1358 }
1359 }
1360 else
1361 {
1362 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1363 Lisp_Object glyph;
1364 int y = s->ybase;
1365 int width = 0;
1366
1367 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1368 {
1369 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1370 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1371 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1372 else
1373 {
1374 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1375
1376 if (j < i)
1377 {
1378 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1379 x += width;
1380 }
1381 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1382 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1383 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1384 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1385 x += wadjust;
1386 j = i + 1;
1387 width = 0;
1388 }
1389 }
1390 if (j < i)
1391 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1392 }
1393 }
1394
1395
1396 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1397
1398 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget P_ ((Widget));
1399 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel P_ ((Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1400 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *));
1401 static void cvt_pixel_dtor P_ ((XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1402 XrmValue *, Cardinal *));
1403
1404
1405 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1406 cannot be determined. */
1407
1408 static struct frame *
1409 x_frame_of_widget (widget)
1410 Widget widget;
1411 {
1412 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1413 Lisp_Object tail;
1414 struct frame *f;
1415
1416 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1417
1418 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1419 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1420 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1421 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1422 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1423 widget = XtParent (widget);
1424
1425 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1426 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1427 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1428 if (FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1429 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1430 (FRAME_X_P (f)
1431 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1432 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1433 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1434 return f;
1435
1436 abort ();
1437 }
1438
1439
1440 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
1441 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
1442 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
1443 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
1444
1445 int
1446 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (widget, cmap, color)
1447 Widget widget;
1448 Colormap cmap;
1449 XColor *color;
1450 {
1451 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1452 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
1453 }
1454
1455
1456 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1457 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1458 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1459 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1460 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1461 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1462
1463 int
1464 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (widget, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1465 Widget widget;
1466 Display *display;
1467 Colormap cmap;
1468 unsigned long *pixel;
1469 double factor;
1470 int delta;
1471 {
1472 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1473 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1474 }
1475
1476
1477 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1478 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1479
1480 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1481 {
1482 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1483 sizeof (Screen *)},
1484 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1485 sizeof (Colormap)}
1486 };
1487
1488
1489 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1490 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1491
1492 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1493
1494
1495 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1496
1497 DPY is the display we are working on.
1498
1499 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1500 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1501 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1502 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1503
1504 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1505 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1506
1507 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1508 we allocated the color or not.
1509
1510 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1511
1512 static Boolean
1513 cvt_string_to_pixel (dpy, args, nargs, from, to, closure_ret)
1514 Display *dpy;
1515 XrmValue *args;
1516 Cardinal *nargs;
1517 XrmValue *from, *to;
1518 XtPointer *closure_ret;
1519 {
1520 Screen *screen;
1521 Colormap cmap;
1522 Pixel pixel;
1523 String color_name;
1524 XColor color;
1525
1526 if (*nargs != 2)
1527 {
1528 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1529 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1530 "XtToolkitError",
1531 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1532 return False;
1533 }
1534
1535 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1536 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1537 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1538
1539 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1540 {
1541 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1542 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1543 }
1544 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1545 {
1546 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1547 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1548 }
1549 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1550 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1551 {
1552 pixel = color.pixel;
1553 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1554 }
1555 else
1556 {
1557 String params[1];
1558 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1559
1560 params[0] = color_name;
1561 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1562 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1563 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1564 params, &nparams);
1565 return False;
1566 }
1567
1568 if (to->addr != NULL)
1569 {
1570 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1571 {
1572 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1573 return False;
1574 }
1575
1576 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1577 }
1578 else
1579 {
1580 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1581 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1582 }
1583
1584 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1585 return True;
1586 }
1587
1588
1589 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1590 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1591 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1592
1593 APP is the application context in which we work.
1594
1595 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1596 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1597 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1598
1599 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1600
1601 static void
1602 cvt_pixel_dtor (app, to, closure, args, nargs)
1603 XtAppContext app;
1604 XrmValuePtr to;
1605 XtPointer closure;
1606 XrmValuePtr args;
1607 Cardinal *nargs;
1608 {
1609 if (*nargs != 2)
1610 {
1611 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1612 "XtToolkitError",
1613 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1614 NULL, NULL);
1615 }
1616 else if (closure != NULL)
1617 {
1618 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1619 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1620 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1621 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1622 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1623 }
1624 }
1625
1626
1627 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1628
1629
1630 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1631 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1632 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1633 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1634
1635 static const XColor *
1636 x_color_cells (dpy, ncells)
1637 Display *dpy;
1638 int *ncells;
1639 {
1640 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1641
1642 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1643 {
1644 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1645 int i;
1646
1647 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1648 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1649 dpyinfo->color_cells
1650 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1651 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1652
1653 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
1654 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1655
1656 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1657 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1658 }
1659
1660 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1661 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1662 }
1663
1664
1665 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1666 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1667
1668 void
1669 x_query_colors (f, colors, ncolors)
1670 struct frame *f;
1671 XColor *colors;
1672 int ncolors;
1673 {
1674 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1675
1676 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1677 {
1678 int i;
1679 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1680 {
1681 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1682 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1683 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1684 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1685 }
1686 }
1687 else
1688 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1689 }
1690
1691
1692 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1693 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1694
1695 void
1696 x_query_color (f, color)
1697 struct frame *f;
1698 XColor *color;
1699 {
1700 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1701 }
1702
1703
1704 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1705 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1706 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1707 allocated. */
1708
1709 static int
1710 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, color)
1711 Display *dpy;
1712 Colormap cmap;
1713 XColor *color;
1714 {
1715 int rc;
1716
1717 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1718 if (rc == 0)
1719 {
1720 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1721 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1722 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1723 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1724 int nearest, i;
1725 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~0;
1726 int ncells;
1727 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1728
1729 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1730 {
1731 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1732 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1733 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1734 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1735
1736 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1737 {
1738 nearest = i;
1739 nearest_delta = delta;
1740 }
1741 }
1742
1743 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1744 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1745 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1746 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1747 }
1748 else
1749 {
1750 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1751 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1752 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1753 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1754 XColor *cached_color;
1755
1756 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1757 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1758 (cached_color->red != color->red
1759 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1760 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1761 {
1762 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1763 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1764 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1765 }
1766 }
1767
1768 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1769 if (rc)
1770 register_color (color->pixel);
1771 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1772
1773 return rc;
1774 }
1775
1776
1777 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1778 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1779 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1780 allocated. */
1781
1782 int
1783 x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color)
1784 struct frame *f;
1785 Colormap cmap;
1786 XColor *color;
1787 {
1788 gamma_correct (f, color);
1789 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1790 }
1791
1792
1793 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1794 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1795 get color reference counts right. */
1796
1797 unsigned long
1798 x_copy_color (f, pixel)
1799 struct frame *f;
1800 unsigned long pixel;
1801 {
1802 XColor color;
1803
1804 color.pixel = pixel;
1805 BLOCK_INPUT;
1806 x_query_color (f, &color);
1807 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1808 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1809 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1810 register_color (pixel);
1811 #endif
1812 return color.pixel;
1813 }
1814
1815
1816 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1817 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1818 get color reference counts right. */
1819
1820 unsigned long
1821 x_copy_dpy_color (dpy, cmap, pixel)
1822 Display *dpy;
1823 Colormap cmap;
1824 unsigned long pixel;
1825 {
1826 XColor color;
1827
1828 color.pixel = pixel;
1829 BLOCK_INPUT;
1830 XQueryColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1831 XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1832 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1833 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1834 register_color (pixel);
1835 #endif
1836 return color.pixel;
1837 }
1838
1839
1840 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1841 boosted.
1842
1843 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1844 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1845 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1846 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1847 use an additional additive factor.
1848
1849 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1850 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1851 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1852
1853
1854 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1855 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1856 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1857 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1858 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1859 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1860
1861 static int
1862 x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1863 struct frame *f;
1864 Display *display;
1865 Colormap cmap;
1866 unsigned long *pixel;
1867 double factor;
1868 int delta;
1869 {
1870 XColor color, new;
1871 long bright;
1872 int success_p;
1873
1874 /* Get RGB color values. */
1875 color.pixel = *pixel;
1876 x_query_color (f, &color);
1877
1878 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1879 xassert (factor >= 0);
1880 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1881 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1882 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1883
1884 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1885 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1886
1887 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1888 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1889 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1890 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1891 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1892 {
1893 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1894 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1895 /* The additive adjustment. */
1896 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1897
1898 if (factor < 1)
1899 {
1900 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1901 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1902 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1903 }
1904 else
1905 {
1906 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1907 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1908 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1909 }
1910 }
1911
1912 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1913 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1914 if (success_p)
1915 {
1916 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1917 {
1918 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1919 delta to the RGB values. */
1920 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1921
1922 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1923 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1924 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1925 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1926 }
1927 else
1928 success_p = 1;
1929 *pixel = new.pixel;
1930 }
1931
1932 return success_p;
1933 }
1934
1935
1936 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1937 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1938 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1939 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1940 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1941 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1942
1943 static void
1944 x_setup_relief_color (f, relief, factor, delta, default_pixel)
1945 struct frame *f;
1946 struct relief *relief;
1947 double factor;
1948 int delta;
1949 unsigned long default_pixel;
1950 {
1951 XGCValues xgcv;
1952 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1953 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1954 unsigned long pixel;
1955 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1956 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1957 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1958 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1959
1960 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1961 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1962
1963 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1964 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1965 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1966 if (relief->gc
1967 && relief->allocated_p)
1968 {
1969 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1970 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1971 }
1972
1973 /* Allocate new color. */
1974 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1975 pixel = background;
1976 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1977 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1978 {
1979 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1980 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1981 }
1982
1983 if (relief->gc == 0)
1984 {
1985 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1986 mask |= GCStipple;
1987 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1988 }
1989 else
1990 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1991 }
1992
1993
1994 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1995
1996 static void
1997 x_setup_relief_colors (s)
1998 struct glyph_string *s;
1999 {
2000 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
2001 unsigned long color;
2002
2003 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
2004 color = s->face->box_color;
2005 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
2006 && s->img->pixmap
2007 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
2008 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
2009 else
2010 {
2011 XGCValues xgcv;
2012
2013 /* Get the background color of the face. */
2014 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
2015 color = xgcv.background;
2016 }
2017
2018 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
2019 || color != di->relief_background)
2020 {
2021 di->relief_background = color;
2022 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
2023 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2024 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
2025 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2026 }
2027 }
2028
2029
2030 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
2031 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
2032 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
2033 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
2034 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
2035 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
2036 when drawing. */
2037
2038 static void
2039 x_draw_relief_rect (f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2040 raised_p, top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2041 struct frame *f;
2042 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width;
2043 int top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, raised_p;
2044 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2045 {
2046 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2047 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2048 int i;
2049 GC gc;
2050
2051 if (raised_p)
2052 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2053 else
2054 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2055 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2056
2057 /* Top. */
2058 if (top_p)
2059 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2060 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2061 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2062 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2063
2064 /* Left. */
2065 if (left_p)
2066 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2067 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2068 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2069
2070 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2071 if (raised_p)
2072 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2073 else
2074 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2075 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2076
2077 /* Bottom. */
2078 if (bot_p)
2079 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2080 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2081 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2082 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2083
2084 /* Right. */
2085 if (right_p)
2086 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2087 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2088 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2089
2090 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2091 }
2092
2093
2094 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2095 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2096 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2097 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2098 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2099 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2100
2101 static void
2102 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2103 left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2104 struct glyph_string *s;
2105 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width, left_p, right_p;
2106 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2107 {
2108 XGCValues xgcv;
2109
2110 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2111 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2112 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2113
2114 /* Top. */
2115 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2116 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2117
2118 /* Left. */
2119 if (left_p)
2120 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2121 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2122
2123 /* Bottom. */
2124 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2125 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2126
2127 /* Right. */
2128 if (right_p)
2129 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2130 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2131
2132 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2133 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2134 }
2135
2136
2137 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2138
2139 static void
2140 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s)
2141 struct glyph_string *s;
2142 {
2143 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2144 int left_p, right_p;
2145 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2146 XRectangle clip_rect;
2147
2148 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2149 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2150 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2151
2152 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2153 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2154 ? s->first_glyph
2155 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2156
2157 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2158 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2159 left_x = s->x;
2160 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2161 ? last_x - 1
2162 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2163 top_y = s->y;
2164 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2165
2166 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2167 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2168 && (s->prev == NULL
2169 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2170 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2171 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2172 && (s->next == NULL
2173 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2174
2175 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2176
2177 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2178 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2179 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2180 else
2181 {
2182 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2183 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2184 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2185 }
2186 }
2187
2188
2189 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2190
2191 static void
2192 x_draw_image_foreground (s)
2193 struct glyph_string *s;
2194 {
2195 int x = s->x;
2196 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2197
2198 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2199 right of that line. */
2200 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2201 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2202 && s->slice.x == 0)
2203 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2204
2205 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2206 by that margin. */
2207 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2208 x += s->img->hmargin;
2209 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2210 y += s->img->vmargin;
2211
2212 if (s->img->pixmap)
2213 {
2214 if (s->img->mask)
2215 {
2216 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2217 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2218 trust on the shape extension to be available
2219 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2220 manually. */
2221 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2222 | GCFunction);
2223 XGCValues xgcv;
2224 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2225
2226 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2227 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2228 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2229 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2230 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2231
2232 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2233 image_rect.x = x;
2234 image_rect.y = y;
2235 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2236 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2237 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2238 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2239 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2240 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2241 }
2242 else
2243 {
2244 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2245
2246 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2247 image_rect.x = x;
2248 image_rect.y = y;
2249 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2250 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2251 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2252 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2253 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2254 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2255
2256 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2257 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2258 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2259 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2260 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2261 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2262 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2263 {
2264 int r = s->img->relief;
2265 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2266 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2267 x - r, y - r,
2268 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2269 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2270 }
2271 }
2272 }
2273 else
2274 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2275 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2276 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2277 }
2278
2279
2280 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2281
2282 static void
2283 x_draw_image_relief (s)
2284 struct glyph_string *s;
2285 {
2286 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
2287 XRectangle r;
2288 int x = s->x;
2289 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2290
2291 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2292 right of that line. */
2293 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2294 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2295 && s->slice.x == 0)
2296 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2297
2298 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2299 by that margin. */
2300 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2301 x += s->img->hmargin;
2302 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2303 y += s->img->vmargin;
2304
2305 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2306 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2307 {
2308 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2309 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2310 }
2311 else
2312 {
2313 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2314 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2315 }
2316
2317 x0 = x - thick;
2318 y0 = y - thick;
2319 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1;
2320 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1;
2321
2322 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2323 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2324 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2325 s->slice.y == 0,
2326 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2327 s->slice.x == 0,
2328 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2329 &r);
2330 }
2331
2332
2333 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2334
2335 static void
2336 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap)
2337 struct glyph_string *s;
2338 Pixmap pixmap;
2339 {
2340 int x = 0;
2341 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2342
2343 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2344 right of that line. */
2345 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2346 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2347 && s->slice.x == 0)
2348 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2349
2350 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2351 by that margin. */
2352 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2353 x += s->img->hmargin;
2354 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2355 y += s->img->vmargin;
2356
2357 if (s->img->pixmap)
2358 {
2359 if (s->img->mask)
2360 {
2361 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2362 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2363 trust on the shape extension to be available
2364 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2365 manually. */
2366 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2367 | GCFunction);
2368 XGCValues xgcv;
2369
2370 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2371 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2372 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2373 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2374 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2375
2376 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2377 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2378 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2379 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2380 }
2381 else
2382 {
2383 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2384 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2385 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2386
2387 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2388 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2389 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2390 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2391 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2392 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2393 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2394 {
2395 int r = s->img->relief;
2396 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2397 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2398 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2399 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2400 }
2401 }
2402 }
2403 else
2404 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2405 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2406 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2407 }
2408
2409
2410 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2411 give the rectangle to draw. */
2412
2413 static void
2414 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
2415 struct glyph_string *s;
2416 int x, y, w, h;
2417 {
2418 if (s->stippled_p)
2419 {
2420 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2421 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2422 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2423 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2424 }
2425 else
2426 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2427 }
2428
2429
2430 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2431
2432 s->y
2433 s->x +-------------------------
2434 | s->face->box
2435 |
2436 | +-------------------------
2437 | | s->img->margin
2438 | |
2439 | | +-------------------
2440 | | | the image
2441
2442 */
2443
2444 static void
2445 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s)
2446 struct glyph_string *s;
2447 {
2448 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2449 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2450 int height;
2451 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2452
2453 height = s->height;
2454 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2455 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2456 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2457 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2458
2459 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2460 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2461 flickering. */
2462 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2463 if (height > s->slice.height
2464 || s->img->hmargin
2465 || s->img->vmargin
2466 || s->img->mask
2467 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2468 || s->width != s->background_width)
2469 {
2470 if (s->img->mask)
2471 {
2472 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2473 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2474 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2475 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2476 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2477
2478 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2479 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2480 s->background_width,
2481 s->height, depth);
2482
2483 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2484 pixmap. */
2485 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2486
2487 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2488 if (s->stippled_p)
2489 {
2490 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2491 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2492 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2493 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2494 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2495 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2496 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2497 }
2498 else
2499 {
2500 XGCValues xgcv;
2501 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2502 &xgcv);
2503 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2504 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2505 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2506 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2507 }
2508 }
2509 else
2510 {
2511 int x = s->x;
2512 int y = s->y;
2513
2514 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2515 && s->slice.x == 0)
2516 x += box_line_hwidth;
2517
2518 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2519 y += box_line_vwidth;
2520
2521 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2522 }
2523
2524 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2525 }
2526
2527 /* Draw the foreground. */
2528 if (pixmap != None)
2529 {
2530 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2531 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2532 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2533 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2534 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2535 }
2536 else
2537 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2538
2539 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2540 if (s->img->relief
2541 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2542 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2543 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2544 }
2545
2546
2547 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2548
2549 static void
2550 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s)
2551 struct glyph_string *s;
2552 {
2553 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2554
2555 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2556 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2557 {
2558 /* If `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor
2559 as wide as the stretch glyph. */
2560 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2561 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2562
2563 if (x < left_x)
2564 {
2565 background_width -= left_x - x;
2566 x = left_x;
2567 }
2568 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2569
2570 /* Draw cursor. */
2571 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2572
2573 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2574 if (width < background_width)
2575 {
2576 int y = s->y;
2577 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2578 XRectangle r;
2579 GC gc;
2580
2581 x += width;
2582 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2583 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2584 {
2585 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2586 gc = s->gc;
2587 }
2588 else
2589 gc = s->face->gc;
2590
2591 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2592 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2593
2594 if (s->face->stipple)
2595 {
2596 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2597 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2598 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2599 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2600 }
2601 else
2602 {
2603 XGCValues xgcv;
2604 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2605 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2606 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2607 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2608 }
2609 }
2610 }
2611 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2612 {
2613 int background_width = s->background_width;
2614 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2615
2616 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2617 except for header line and mode line. */
2618 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2619 {
2620 background_width -= left_x - x;
2621 x = left_x;
2622 }
2623 if (background_width > 0)
2624 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2625 }
2626
2627 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2628 }
2629
2630
2631 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2632
2633 static void
2634 x_draw_glyph_string (s)
2635 struct glyph_string *s;
2636 {
2637 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2638
2639 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2640 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2641 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2642 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2643 {
2644 int width;
2645 struct glyph_string *next;
2646
2647 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
2648 next && width < s->right_overhang;
2649 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2650 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2651 {
2652 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2653 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2654 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
2655 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
2656 else
2657 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2658 next->num_clips = 0;
2659 }
2660 }
2661
2662 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2663 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2664
2665 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2666 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2667 if (!s->for_overlaps
2668 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2669 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2670 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2671
2672 {
2673 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2674 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2675 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2676 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2677 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2678 }
2679 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2680 && !s->clip_tail
2681 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2682 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
2683 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2684 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2685 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2686 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2687 else
2688 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2689
2690 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2691 {
2692 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2693 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2694 break;
2695
2696 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2697 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2698 break;
2699
2700 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2701 if (s->for_overlaps)
2702 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2703 else
2704 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2705 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2706 break;
2707
2708 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2709 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
2710 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
2711 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2712 else
2713 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2714 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2715 break;
2716
2717 default:
2718 abort ();
2719 }
2720
2721 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2722 {
2723 /* Draw underline. */
2724 if (s->face->underline_p)
2725 {
2726 unsigned long thickness, position;
2727 int y;
2728
2729 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p)
2730 {
2731 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2732 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
2733 position = s->prev->underline_position;
2734 }
2735 else
2736 {
2737 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2738 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
2739 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
2740 else
2741 thickness = 1;
2742 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
2743 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2744 else
2745 {
2746 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2747 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2748 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2749 specs, and its default is
2750
2751 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2752 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2753
2754 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2755 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
2756 position = s->font->underline_position;
2757 else if (s->font)
2758 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
2759 else
2760 position = underline_minimum_offset;
2761 }
2762 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
2763 }
2764 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2765 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2766 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
2767 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2768 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
2769 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
2770 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
2771 s->underline_position = position;
2772 y = s->ybase + position;
2773 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2774 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2775 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2776 else
2777 {
2778 XGCValues xgcv;
2779 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2780 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2781 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2782 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2783 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2784 }
2785 }
2786
2787 /* Draw overline. */
2788 if (s->face->overline_p)
2789 {
2790 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2791
2792 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2793 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2794 s->width, h);
2795 else
2796 {
2797 XGCValues xgcv;
2798 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2799 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2800 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2801 s->width, h);
2802 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2803 }
2804 }
2805
2806 /* Draw strike-through. */
2807 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2808 {
2809 unsigned long h = 1;
2810 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2811
2812 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2813 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2814 s->width, h);
2815 else
2816 {
2817 XGCValues xgcv;
2818 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2819 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2820 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2821 s->width, h);
2822 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2823 }
2824 }
2825
2826 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2827 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2828 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2829
2830 if (s->prev)
2831 {
2832 struct glyph_string *prev;
2833
2834 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
2835 if (prev->hl != s->hl
2836 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
2837 {
2838 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2839 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2840 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
2841
2842 prev->hl = s->hl;
2843 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
2844 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
2845 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2846 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2847 else
2848 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2849 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
2850 prev->hl = save;
2851 prev->num_clips = 0;
2852 }
2853 }
2854
2855 if (s->next)
2856 {
2857 struct glyph_string *next;
2858
2859 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
2860 if (next->hl != s->hl
2861 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
2862 {
2863 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2864 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2865 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
2866
2867 next->hl = s->hl;
2868 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2869 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
2870 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2871 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2872 else
2873 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2874 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
2875 next->hl = save;
2876 next->num_clips = 0;
2877 }
2878 }
2879 }
2880
2881 /* Reset clipping. */
2882 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2883 s->num_clips = 0;
2884 }
2885
2886 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2887
2888 void
2889 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (f, x, y, width, height, shift_by)
2890 struct frame *f;
2891 int x, y, width, height, shift_by;
2892 {
2893 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2894 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2895 x, y, width, height,
2896 x + shift_by, y);
2897 }
2898
2899 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2900 for X frames. */
2901
2902 static void
2903 x_delete_glyphs (f, n)
2904 struct frame *f;
2905 register int n;
2906 {
2907 abort ();
2908 }
2909
2910
2911 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2912 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2913
2914 void
2915 x_clear_area (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures)
2916 Display *dpy;
2917 Window window;
2918 int x, y;
2919 int width, height;
2920 int exposures;
2921 {
2922 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2923 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2924 }
2925
2926
2927 /* Clear an entire frame. */
2928
2929 static void
2930 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
2931 {
2932 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2933 longer visible. */
2934 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2935 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2936 output_cursor.x = -1;
2937
2938 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2939 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2940 BLOCK_INPUT;
2941 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
2942
2943 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
2944 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
2945 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2946
2947 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2948
2949 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2950 }
2951
2952
2953 \f
2954 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2955
2956 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2957 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2958
2959 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2960
2961
2962 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2963 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2964
2965 static int
2966 timeval_subtract (result, x, y)
2967 struct timeval *result, x, y;
2968 {
2969 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
2970 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
2971 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
2972 {
2973 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
2974 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
2975 y.tv_sec += nsec;
2976 }
2977
2978 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
2979 {
2980 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
2981 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
2982 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
2983 }
2984
2985 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
2986 positive. */
2987 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
2988 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
2989
2990 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
2991 negative. */
2992 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
2993 }
2994
2995 void
2996 XTflash (f)
2997 struct frame *f;
2998 {
2999 BLOCK_INPUT;
3000
3001 {
3002 GC gc;
3003
3004 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3005 pixels into background pixels. */
3006 {
3007 XGCValues values;
3008
3009 values.function = GXxor;
3010 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3011 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3012
3013 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3014 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
3015 }
3016
3017 {
3018 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3019 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
3020 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3021 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
3022 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3023 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3024 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3025
3026 int width;
3027
3028 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
3029 edge it is next to. */
3030 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
3031 {
3032 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
3033 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3034 break;
3035
3036 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
3037 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3038 break;
3039
3040 default:
3041 break;
3042 }
3043
3044 width = flash_right - flash_left;
3045
3046 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3047 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3048 {
3049 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3050 flash_left,
3051 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3052 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
3053 width, flash_height);
3054 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3055 flash_left,
3056 (height - flash_height
3057 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3058 width, flash_height);
3059 }
3060 else
3061 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3062 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3063 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3064 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3065
3066 x_flush (f);
3067
3068 {
3069 struct timeval wakeup;
3070
3071 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
3072
3073 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
3074 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
3075 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
3076 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
3077
3078 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3079 available. */
3080 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3081 {
3082 struct timeval current;
3083 struct timeval timeout;
3084
3085 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
3086
3087 /* Break if result would be negative. */
3088 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
3089 break;
3090
3091 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3092 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
3093 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
3094
3095 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3096 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
3097 }
3098 }
3099
3100 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3101 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3102 {
3103 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3104 flash_left,
3105 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3106 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
3107 width, flash_height);
3108 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3109 flash_left,
3110 (height - flash_height
3111 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3112 width, flash_height);
3113 }
3114 else
3115 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3116 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3117 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3118 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3119
3120 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3121 x_flush (f);
3122 }
3123 }
3124
3125 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3126 }
3127
3128 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3129
3130
3131 /* Make audible bell. */
3132
3133 void
3134 XTring_bell ()
3135 {
3136 struct frame *f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3137
3138 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3139 {
3140 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3141 if (visible_bell)
3142 XTflash (f);
3143 else
3144 #endif
3145 {
3146 BLOCK_INPUT;
3147 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3148 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3149 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3150 }
3151 }
3152 }
3153
3154 \f
3155 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3156 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3157 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3158 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3159
3160 static void
3161 XTset_terminal_window (n)
3162 register int n;
3163 {
3164 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3165 }
3166
3167
3168 \f
3169 /***********************************************************************
3170 Line Dance
3171 ***********************************************************************/
3172
3173 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3174 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3175
3176 static void
3177 x_ins_del_lines (f, vpos, n)
3178 struct frame *f;
3179 int vpos, n;
3180 {
3181 abort ();
3182 }
3183
3184
3185 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3186
3187 static void
3188 x_scroll_run (w, run)
3189 struct window *w;
3190 struct run *run;
3191 {
3192 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3193 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3194
3195 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3196 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3197 fringe of W. */
3198 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3199
3200 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3201 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3202 bottom_y = y + height;
3203
3204 if (to_y < from_y)
3205 {
3206 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3207 line at the bottom. */
3208 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3209 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3210 else
3211 height = run->height;
3212 }
3213 else
3214 {
3215 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3216 at the bottom. */
3217 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3218 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3219 else
3220 height = run->height;
3221 }
3222
3223 BLOCK_INPUT;
3224
3225 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3226 updated_window = w;
3227 x_clear_cursor (w);
3228
3229 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3230 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3231 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3232 x, from_y,
3233 width, height,
3234 x, to_y);
3235
3236 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3237 }
3238
3239
3240 \f
3241 /***********************************************************************
3242 Exposure Events
3243 ***********************************************************************/
3244
3245 \f
3246 static void
3247 frame_highlight (f)
3248 struct frame *f;
3249 {
3250 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3251 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3252 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3253 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3254 BLOCK_INPUT;
3255 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3256 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3257 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3258 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3259 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3260 }
3261
3262 static void
3263 frame_unhighlight (f)
3264 struct frame *f;
3265 {
3266 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3267 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3268 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3269 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3270 BLOCK_INPUT;
3271 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3272 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3273 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3274 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3275 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3276 }
3277
3278 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3279 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3280 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3281 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3282 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3283
3284 static void
3285 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame)
3286 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3287 struct frame *frame;
3288 {
3289 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3290
3291 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3292 {
3293 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3294 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3295 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3296
3297 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3298 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3299
3300 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3301 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3302 else
3303 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3304 }
3305
3306 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3307 }
3308
3309 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3310 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3311 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3312
3313 static void
3314 x_focus_changed (type, state, dpyinfo, frame, bufp)
3315 int type;
3316 int state;
3317 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3318 struct frame *frame;
3319 struct input_event *bufp;
3320 {
3321 if (type == FocusIn)
3322 {
3323 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3324 {
3325 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3326 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3327
3328 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3329 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3330 if (NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3331 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3332 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3333 {
3334 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3335 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3336 }
3337 }
3338
3339 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3340
3341 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3342 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3343 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3344 #endif
3345 }
3346 else if (type == FocusOut)
3347 {
3348 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3349
3350 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3351 {
3352 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3353 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3354 }
3355
3356 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3357 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3358 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3359 #endif
3360 }
3361 }
3362
3363 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3364 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3365
3366 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3367
3368 static void
3369 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, event, bufp)
3370 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3371 XEvent *event;
3372 struct input_event *bufp;
3373 {
3374 struct frame *frame;
3375
3376 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3377 if (! frame)
3378 return;
3379
3380 switch (event->type)
3381 {
3382 case EnterNotify:
3383 case LeaveNotify:
3384 {
3385 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3386 int focus_state
3387 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3388
3389 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3390 && event->xcrossing.focus
3391 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3392 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3393 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3394 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3395 }
3396 break;
3397
3398 case FocusIn:
3399 case FocusOut:
3400 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3401 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3402 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3403 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3404 break;
3405
3406 case ClientMessage:
3407 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3408 {
3409 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3410 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3411 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3412 }
3413 break;
3414 }
3415 }
3416
3417
3418 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3419
3420 void
3421 x_mouse_leave (dpyinfo)
3422 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3423 {
3424 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3425 }
3426
3427 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3428 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3429 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3430
3431 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3432 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3433 the appropriate X display info. */
3434
3435 static void
3436 XTframe_rehighlight (frame)
3437 struct frame *frame;
3438 {
3439 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3440 }
3441
3442 static void
3443 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo)
3444 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3445 {
3446 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3447
3448 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3449 {
3450 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3451 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3452 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3453 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3454 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3455 {
3456 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3457 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3458 }
3459 }
3460 else
3461 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3462
3463 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3464 {
3465 if (old_highlight)
3466 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3467 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3468 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3469 }
3470 }
3471
3472
3473 \f
3474 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3475
3476 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3477 static void
3478 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo)
3479 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3480 {
3481 int min_code, max_code;
3482 KeySym *syms;
3483 int syms_per_code;
3484 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3485
3486 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3487 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3488 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3489 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3490 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3491
3492 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3493
3494 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3495 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3496 &syms_per_code);
3497 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3498
3499 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3500 Alt keysyms are on. */
3501 {
3502 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3503 int found_alt_or_meta;
3504
3505 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3506 {
3507 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3508 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3509 {
3510 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3511
3512 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3513 if (code == 0)
3514 continue;
3515
3516 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3517 {
3518 int code_col;
3519
3520 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3521 {
3522 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3523
3524 switch (sym)
3525 {
3526 case XK_Meta_L:
3527 case XK_Meta_R:
3528 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3529 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3530 break;
3531
3532 case XK_Alt_L:
3533 case XK_Alt_R:
3534 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3535 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3536 break;
3537
3538 case XK_Hyper_L:
3539 case XK_Hyper_R:
3540 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3541 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3542 code_col = syms_per_code;
3543 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3544 break;
3545
3546 case XK_Super_L:
3547 case XK_Super_R:
3548 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3549 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3550 code_col = syms_per_code;
3551 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3552 break;
3553
3554 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3555 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3556 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3557 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3558 code_col = syms_per_code;
3559 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3560 break;
3561 }
3562 }
3563 }
3564 }
3565 }
3566 }
3567
3568 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3569 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3570 {
3571 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3572 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3573 }
3574
3575 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3576 make them just meta, not alt. */
3577 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3578 {
3579 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3580 }
3581
3582 XFree ((char *) syms);
3583 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3584 }
3585
3586 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3587 Emacs uses. */
3588
3589 unsigned int
3590 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3591 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3592 unsigned int state;
3593 {
3594 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3595 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3596 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3597 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3598 Lisp_Object tem;
3599
3600 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3601 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3602 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3603 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3604 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3605 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3606 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3607 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3608
3609
3610 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3611 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3612 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3613 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3614 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3615 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3616 }
3617
3618 static unsigned int
3619 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3620 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3621 unsigned int state;
3622 {
3623 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3624 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3625 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3626 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3627
3628 Lisp_Object tem;
3629
3630 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3631 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3632 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3633 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3634 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3635 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3636 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3637 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3638
3639
3640 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3641 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3642 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3643 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3644 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3645 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3646 }
3647
3648 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3649
3650 char *
3651 x_get_keysym_name (keysym)
3652 KeySym keysym;
3653 {
3654 char *value;
3655
3656 BLOCK_INPUT;
3657 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3658 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3659
3660 return value;
3661 }
3662
3663
3664 \f
3665 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3666
3667 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3668
3669 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3670 the mouse. */
3671
3672 static Lisp_Object
3673 construct_mouse_click (result, event, f)
3674 struct input_event *result;
3675 XButtonEvent *event;
3676 struct frame *f;
3677 {
3678 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3679 otherwise. */
3680 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3681 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3682 result->timestamp = event->time;
3683 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3684 event->state)
3685 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3686 ? up_modifier
3687 : down_modifier));
3688
3689 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3690 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3691 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3692 result->arg = Qnil;
3693 return Qnil;
3694 }
3695
3696 \f
3697 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3698 The input handler calls this.
3699
3700 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3701 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3702 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3703 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3704
3705 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3706 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3707
3708 static int
3709 note_mouse_movement (frame, event)
3710 FRAME_PTR frame;
3711 XMotionEvent *event;
3712 {
3713 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3714 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3715 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3716
3717 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3718 return 0;
3719
3720 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3721 {
3722 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3723 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3724 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3725 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3726 return 1;
3727 }
3728
3729
3730 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3731 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3732 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3733 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3734 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3735 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3736 {
3737 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3738 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3739 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3740 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3741 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3742 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3743 return 1;
3744 }
3745
3746 return 0;
3747 }
3748
3749 \f
3750 /************************************************************************
3751 Mouse Face
3752 ************************************************************************/
3753
3754 static void
3755 redo_mouse_highlight ()
3756 {
3757 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3758 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3759 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3760 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3761 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3762 }
3763
3764
3765
3766 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3767 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3768
3769 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3770 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3771 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3772 position on the scroll bar.
3773
3774 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3775 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3776 the mouse is over.
3777
3778 Set *TIME to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3779 was at this position.
3780
3781 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3782
3783 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3784 movement. */
3785
3786 static void
3787 XTmouse_position (fp, insist, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
3788 FRAME_PTR *fp;
3789 int insist;
3790 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
3791 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
3792 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
3793 unsigned long *time;
3794 {
3795 FRAME_PTR f1;
3796
3797 BLOCK_INPUT;
3798
3799 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3800 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time);
3801 else
3802 {
3803 Window root;
3804 int root_x, root_y;
3805
3806 Window dummy_window;
3807 int dummy;
3808
3809 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3810
3811 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3812 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3813 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
3814 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3815 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3816
3817 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3818
3819 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3820 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3821 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3822
3823 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3824 &root,
3825
3826 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3827 a different screen. */
3828 &dummy_window,
3829
3830 /* The position on that root window. */
3831 &root_x, &root_y,
3832
3833 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3834 &dummy, &dummy,
3835
3836 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3837 we don't care. */
3838 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3839
3840 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3841 containing the pointer. */
3842 {
3843 Window win, child;
3844 int win_x, win_y;
3845 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3846
3847 win = root;
3848
3849 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3850 structure is changing at the same time this function
3851 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3852
3853 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3854
3855 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3856 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3857 {
3858 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3859 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3860 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3861
3862 /* From-window, to-window. */
3863 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3864
3865 /* From-position, to-position. */
3866 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3867
3868 /* Child of win. */
3869 &child);
3870 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3871 }
3872 else
3873 {
3874 while (1)
3875 {
3876 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3877
3878 /* From-window, to-window. */
3879 root, win,
3880
3881 /* From-position, to-position. */
3882 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3883
3884 /* Child of win. */
3885 &child);
3886
3887 if (child == None || child == win)
3888 break;
3889
3890 win = child;
3891 parent_x = win_x;
3892 parent_y = win_y;
3893 }
3894
3895 /* Now we know that:
3896 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3897 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3898 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3899 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3900 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3901 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3902 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3903 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3904 never use them in that case.) */
3905
3906 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3907 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3908
3909 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3910 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
3911 on the frame. */
3912 if (f1 != NULL
3913 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
3914 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
3915 f1 = NULL;
3916 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3917 }
3918
3919 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
3920 f1 = 0;
3921
3922 x_uncatch_errors ();
3923
3924 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
3925 if (! f1)
3926 {
3927 struct scroll_bar *bar;
3928
3929 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
3930
3931 if (bar)
3932 {
3933 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
3934 win_x = parent_x;
3935 win_y = parent_y;
3936 }
3937 }
3938
3939 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
3940 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3941
3942 if (f1)
3943 {
3944 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
3945 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
3946 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
3947 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
3948 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
3949 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
3950 the frame are divided into. */
3951
3952 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3953 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
3954
3955 *bar_window = Qnil;
3956 *part = 0;
3957 *fp = f1;
3958 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
3959 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
3960 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
3961 }
3962 }
3963 }
3964
3965 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3966 }
3967
3968
3969 \f
3970 /***********************************************************************
3971 Scroll bars
3972 ***********************************************************************/
3973
3974 /* Scroll bar support. */
3975
3976 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
3977 manages it.
3978 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
3979 bits. */
3980
3981 static struct scroll_bar *
3982 x_window_to_scroll_bar (display, window_id)
3983 Display *display;
3984 Window window_id;
3985 {
3986 Lisp_Object tail;
3987
3988 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
3989 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
3990 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
3991
3992 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
3993 {
3994 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
3995
3996 frame = XCAR (tail);
3997 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
3998 if (! FRAMEP (frame))
3999 abort ();
4000
4001 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4002 continue;
4003
4004 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4005 right window ID. */
4006 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4007 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4008 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4009 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4010 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
4011 condemned = Qnil,
4012 ! NILP (bar));
4013 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
4014 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id &&
4015 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
4016 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
4017 }
4018
4019 return 0;
4020 }
4021
4022
4023 #if defined USE_LUCID
4024
4025 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4026 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4027
4028 static Widget
4029 x_window_to_menu_bar (window)
4030 Window window;
4031 {
4032 Lisp_Object tail;
4033
4034 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4035 {
4036 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (XCAR (tail))))
4037 {
4038 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
4039 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
4040
4041 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
4042 return menu_bar;
4043 }
4044 }
4045
4046 return NULL;
4047 }
4048
4049 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4050
4051 \f
4052 /************************************************************************
4053 Toolkit scroll bars
4054 ************************************************************************/
4055
4056 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4057
4058 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event P_ ((XEvent *, struct input_event *));
4059 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event P_ ((Lisp_Object, int, int, int));
4060 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar P_ ((struct frame *,
4061 struct scroll_bar *));
4062 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb P_ ((struct scroll_bar *,
4063 int, int, int));
4064
4065
4066 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4067 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4068
4069 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4070
4071 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4072
4073 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4074
4075 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4076 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4077
4078 #ifndef USE_GTK
4079 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4080
4081 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4082
4083 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4084
4085 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4086 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4087 to avoid jerkyness. */
4088
4089 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4090
4091 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4092 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4093 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4094 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4095
4096 static void
4097 xt_action_hook (widget, client_data, action_name, event, params,
4098 num_params)
4099 Widget widget;
4100 XtPointer client_data;
4101 String action_name;
4102 XEvent *event;
4103 String *params;
4104 Cardinal *num_params;
4105 {
4106 int scroll_bar_p;
4107 char *end_action;
4108
4109 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4110 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4111 end_action = "Release";
4112 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4113 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4114 end_action = "EndScroll";
4115 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4116
4117 if (scroll_bar_p
4118 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4119 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4120 {
4121 struct window *w;
4122
4123 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4124 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4125 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4126
4127 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4128 {
4129 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4130 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4131 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4132 }
4133 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4134 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4135
4136 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4137 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4138 }
4139 }
4140 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4141
4142 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4143 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4144
4145 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4146 static int scroll_bar_windows_size;
4147
4148
4149 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4150 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4151 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4152 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4153
4154 static void
4155 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window, part, portion, whole)
4156 Lisp_Object window;
4157 int part, portion, whole;
4158 {
4159 XEvent event;
4160 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4161 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4162 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4163 int i;
4164
4165 BLOCK_INPUT;
4166
4167 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4168 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4169 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4170 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4171 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4172 ev->format = 32;
4173
4174 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4175 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4176 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4177 into that array in the event. */
4178 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4179 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4180 break;
4181
4182 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4183 {
4184 int new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
4185 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4186 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4187
4188 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
4189 nbytes);
4190 bzero (&scroll_bar_windows[i], nbytes - old_nbytes);
4191 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
4192 }
4193
4194 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4195 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4196 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4197 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4198 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4199 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4200
4201 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4202 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4203 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4204 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4205 #endif
4206
4207 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4208 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4209 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4210 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4211 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4212 }
4213
4214
4215 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4216 in *IEVENT. */
4217
4218 static void
4219 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event, ievent)
4220 XEvent *event;
4221 struct input_event *ievent;
4222 {
4223 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4224 Lisp_Object window;
4225 struct frame *f;
4226 struct window *w;
4227
4228 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4229 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4230
4231 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4232 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4233
4234 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4235 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4236 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4237 #ifdef USE_GTK
4238 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4239 #else
4240 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
4241 #endif
4242 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4243 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4244 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4245 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4246 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4247 }
4248
4249
4250 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4251
4252 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4253
4254 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4255
4256
4257 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4258 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4259 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4260
4261 static void
4262 xm_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4263 Widget widget;
4264 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4265 {
4266 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4267 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4268 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4269
4270 switch (cs->reason)
4271 {
4272 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4273 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4274 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4275 break;
4276
4277 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4278 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4279 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4280 break;
4281
4282 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4283 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4284 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4285 break;
4286
4287 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4288 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4289 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4290 break;
4291
4292 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4293 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4294 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4295 break;
4296
4297 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4298 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4299 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4300 break;
4301
4302 case XmCR_DRAG:
4303 {
4304 int slider_size;
4305
4306 /* Get the slider size. */
4307 BLOCK_INPUT;
4308 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4309 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4310
4311 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4312 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4313 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4314 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4315 }
4316 break;
4317
4318 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4319 break;
4320 };
4321
4322 if (part >= 0)
4323 {
4324 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4325 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4326 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4327 }
4328 }
4329
4330 #elif defined USE_GTK
4331
4332 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4333 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4334
4335 static void
4336 xg_scroll_callback (widget, data)
4337 GtkRange *widget;
4338 gpointer data;
4339 {
4340 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) data;
4341 gdouble previous;
4342 gdouble position;
4343 gdouble *p;
4344 int diff;
4345
4346 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4347 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (widget));
4348
4349 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4350
4351 p = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA);
4352 if (! p)
4353 {
4354 p = (gdouble*) xmalloc (sizeof (gdouble));
4355 *p = XG_SB_MIN;
4356 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA, p);
4357 }
4358
4359 previous = *p;
4360 *p = position;
4361
4362 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return;
4363
4364 diff = (int) (position - previous);
4365
4366 if (diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4367 {
4368 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4369 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4370 }
4371 else if (-diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4372 {
4373 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4374 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4375 }
4376 else if (diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4377 {
4378 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4379 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4380 }
4381 else if (-diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4382 {
4383 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4384 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4385 }
4386 else
4387 {
4388 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4389 whole = adj->upper - adj->page_size;
4390 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4391 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4392 }
4393
4394 if (part >= 0)
4395 {
4396 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4397 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4398 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4399 }
4400 }
4401
4402 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4403
4404 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4405 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4406 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4407 the thumb is. */
4408
4409 static void
4410 xaw_jump_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4411 Widget widget;
4412 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4413 {
4414 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4415 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4416 float shown;
4417 int whole, portion, height;
4418 int part;
4419
4420 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4421 BLOCK_INPUT;
4422 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4423 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4424
4425 whole = 10000000;
4426 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4427
4428 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4429 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4430 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4431 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4432 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4433 bottom). */
4434 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4435 else
4436 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4437
4438 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4439 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4440 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4441 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4442 }
4443
4444
4445 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4446 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4447 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4448 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4449 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4450 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4451 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4452
4453 static void
4454 xaw_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4455 Widget widget;
4456 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4457 {
4458 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4459 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4460 int position = (long) call_data;
4461 Dimension height;
4462 int part;
4463
4464 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4465 BLOCK_INPUT;
4466 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4467 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4468
4469 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4470 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4471
4472 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4473 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4474 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4475 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4476 else
4477 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4478
4479 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4480 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4481 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4482 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4483 }
4484
4485 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4486
4487 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4488
4489 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4490 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4491
4492 #ifdef USE_GTK
4493 static void
4494 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4495 struct frame *f;
4496 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4497 {
4498 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4499
4500 BLOCK_INPUT;
4501 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4502 scroll_bar_name);
4503 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4504 }
4505
4506 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4507
4508 static void
4509 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4510 struct frame *f;
4511 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4512 {
4513 Window xwindow;
4514 Widget widget;
4515 Arg av[20];
4516 int ac = 0;
4517 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4518 unsigned long pixel;
4519
4520 BLOCK_INPUT;
4521
4522 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4523 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4524 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4525 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4526 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4527 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4528 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4529 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4530 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4531
4532 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4533 if (pixel != -1)
4534 {
4535 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4536 ++ac;
4537 }
4538
4539 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4540 if (pixel != -1)
4541 {
4542 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4543 ++ac;
4544 }
4545
4546 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4547 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4548
4549 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4550 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4551 (XtPointer) bar);
4552 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4553 (XtPointer) bar);
4554 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4555 (XtPointer) bar);
4556 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4557 (XtPointer) bar);
4558 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4559 (XtPointer) bar);
4560 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4561 (XtPointer) bar);
4562 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4563 (XtPointer) bar);
4564
4565 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4566 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4567
4568 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4569 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4570 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4571 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4572
4573 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4574
4575 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4576 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4577 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4578 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4579 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4580 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4581 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4582 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4583
4584 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4585 if (pixel != -1)
4586 {
4587 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4588 ++ac;
4589 }
4590
4591 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4592 if (pixel != -1)
4593 {
4594 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4595 ++ac;
4596 }
4597
4598 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4599
4600 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4601 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4602 {
4603 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4604 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4605 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4606 pixel = -1;
4607 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4608 }
4609 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4610 {
4611 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4612 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4613 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4614 pixel = -1;
4615 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4616 }
4617
4618 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4619 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4620 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4621 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4622 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4623 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4624 {
4625 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, True);
4626 ++ac;
4627 }
4628 else
4629 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4630 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4631 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4632 {
4633 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4634 the shadows. */
4635 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4636 ++ac;
4637
4638 /* Specify the colors. */
4639 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4640 if (pixel != -1)
4641 {
4642 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4643 ++ac;
4644 }
4645 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4646 if (pixel != -1)
4647 {
4648 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4649 ++ac;
4650 }
4651 }
4652 #endif
4653
4654 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4655 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4656
4657 {
4658 char *initial = "";
4659 char *val = initial;
4660 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4661 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4662 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4663 #endif
4664 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4665 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4666 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4667 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4668 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4669 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4670 }
4671 }
4672
4673 /* Define callbacks. */
4674 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4675 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4676 (XtPointer) bar);
4677
4678 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4679 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4680
4681 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4682
4683 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4684 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4685 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4686 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4687
4688 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4689 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4690 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4691 bar->x_window = xwindow;
4692
4693 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4694 }
4695 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4696
4697
4698 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4699 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4700
4701 #ifdef USE_GTK
4702 static void
4703 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4704 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4705 int portion, position, whole;
4706 {
4707 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4708 }
4709
4710 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4711 static void
4712 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4713 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4714 int portion, position, whole;
4715 {
4716 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4717 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4718 float top, shown;
4719
4720 BLOCK_INPUT;
4721
4722 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4723
4724 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4725 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4726 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4727 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4728 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4729 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4730 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4731 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4732 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4733 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4734 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4735 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4736 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4737 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4738 whole += portion;
4739
4740 if (whole <= 0)
4741 top = 0, shown = 1;
4742 else
4743 {
4744 top = (float) position / whole;
4745 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4746 }
4747
4748 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4749 {
4750 int size, value;
4751
4752 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4753 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4754 value. */
4755 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4756 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4757 size = max (size, 1);
4758
4759 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4760 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4761 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4762
4763 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4764 }
4765 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4766
4767 if (whole == 0)
4768 top = 0, shown = 1;
4769 else
4770 {
4771 top = (float) position / whole;
4772 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4773 }
4774
4775 {
4776 float old_top, old_shown;
4777 Dimension height;
4778 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4779 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4780 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4781 XtNheight, &height,
4782 NULL);
4783
4784 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4785 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4786 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4787 else
4788 top = old_top;
4789 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4790 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
4791
4792 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4793 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4794 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4795 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4796 {
4797 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4798 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4799 else
4800 {
4801 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4802 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4803 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4804
4805 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4806 }
4807 }
4808 }
4809 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4810
4811 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4812 }
4813 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4814
4815 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4816
4817
4818 \f
4819 /************************************************************************
4820 Scroll bars, general
4821 ************************************************************************/
4822
4823 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4824 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4825 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4826 scroll bar. */
4827
4828 static struct scroll_bar *
4829 x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, left, width, height)
4830 struct window *w;
4831 int top, left, width, height;
4832 {
4833 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4834 struct scroll_bar *bar
4835 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
4836
4837 BLOCK_INPUT;
4838
4839 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4840 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4841 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4842 {
4843 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4844 unsigned long mask;
4845 Window window;
4846
4847 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4848 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4849 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
4850
4851 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4852 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4853 | ExposureMask);
4854 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4855
4856 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4857
4858 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4859 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4860 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4861 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4862 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4863 left, top, width,
4864 window_box_height (w), False);
4865
4866 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4867 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4868 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4869 top,
4870 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4871 height,
4872 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4873 0,
4874 CopyFromParent,
4875 CopyFromParent,
4876 CopyFromParent,
4877 /* Attributes. */
4878 mask, &a);
4879 bar->x_window = window;
4880 }
4881 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4882
4883 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4884 bar->top = top;
4885 bar->left = left;
4886 bar->width = width;
4887 bar->height = height;
4888 bar->start = 0;
4889 bar->end = 0;
4890 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4891 bar->fringe_extended_p = 0;
4892
4893 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4894 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4895 bar->prev = Qnil;
4896 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
4897 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4898 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4899
4900 /* Map the window/widget. */
4901 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4902 {
4903 #ifdef USE_GTK
4904 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4905 bar->x_window,
4906 top,
4907 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4908 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4909 max (height, 1));
4910 xg_show_scroll_bar (bar->x_window);
4911 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4912 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4913 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
4914 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4915 top,
4916 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4917 max (height, 1), 0);
4918 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
4919 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4920 }
4921 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4922 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
4923 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4924
4925 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4926 return bar;
4927 }
4928
4929
4930 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4931
4932 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
4933
4934 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
4935 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
4936 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
4937 events.)
4938
4939 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
4940 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
4941 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
4942 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
4943 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
4944
4945 static void
4946 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, rebuild)
4947 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4948 int start, end;
4949 int rebuild;
4950 {
4951 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
4952 Window w = bar->x_window;
4953 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4954 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
4955
4956 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
4957 if (! rebuild
4958 && start == bar->start
4959 && end == bar->end)
4960 return;
4961
4962 BLOCK_INPUT;
4963
4964 {
4965 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
4966 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
4967 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
4968
4969 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
4970 the distance between start and end. */
4971 {
4972 int length = end - start;
4973
4974 if (start < 0)
4975 start = 0;
4976 else if (start > top_range)
4977 start = top_range;
4978 end = start + length;
4979
4980 if (end < start)
4981 end = start;
4982 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
4983 end = top_range;
4984 }
4985
4986 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
4987 bar->start = start;
4988 bar->end = end;
4989
4990 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
4991 if (end > top_range)
4992 end = top_range;
4993
4994 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
4995 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
4996 that many pixels tall. */
4997 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
4998
4999 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5000 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5001 if (0 < start)
5002 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5003 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5004 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5005 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
5006 inside_width, start,
5007 False);
5008
5009 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5010 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5011 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5012 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5013
5014 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5015 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5016 /* x, y, width, height */
5017 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5018 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
5019 inside_width, end - start);
5020
5021 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5022 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5023 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5024 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5025
5026 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5027 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5028 if (end < inside_height)
5029 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5030 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5031 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5032 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
5033 inside_width, inside_height - end,
5034 False);
5035
5036 }
5037
5038 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5039 }
5040
5041 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5042
5043 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5044 nil. */
5045
5046 static void
5047 x_scroll_bar_remove (bar)
5048 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5049 {
5050 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5051 BLOCK_INPUT;
5052
5053 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5054 #ifdef USE_GTK
5055 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
5056 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5057 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5058 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5059 #else
5060 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5061 #endif
5062
5063 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5064 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5065
5066 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5067 }
5068
5069
5070 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5071 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5072 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5073 create one. */
5074
5075 static void
5076 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, portion, whole, position)
5077 struct window *w;
5078 int portion, whole, position;
5079 {
5080 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5081 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5082 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5083 int window_y, window_height;
5084 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5085 int fringe_extended_p;
5086 #endif
5087
5088 /* Get window dimensions. */
5089 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5090 top = window_y;
5091 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5092 height = window_height;
5093
5094 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5095 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5096
5097 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5098 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5099 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5100 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5101 else
5102 sb_width = width;
5103
5104 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5105 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5106 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5107 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w) ? width - sb_width : 0);
5108 else
5109 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w) ? 0 : width - sb_width);
5110 #else
5111 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5112 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5113 else
5114 sb_left = left;
5115 #endif
5116
5117 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5118 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5119 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5120 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5121 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5122 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5123 else
5124 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5125 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5126 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5127 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5128 #endif
5129
5130 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5131 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5132 {
5133 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5134 {
5135 BLOCK_INPUT;
5136 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5137 if (fringe_extended_p)
5138 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5139 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5140 else
5141 #endif
5142 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5143 left, top, width, height, False);
5144 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5145 }
5146
5147 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5148 }
5149 else
5150 {
5151 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5152 unsigned int mask = 0;
5153
5154 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5155
5156 BLOCK_INPUT;
5157
5158 if (sb_left != bar->left)
5159 mask |= CWX;
5160 if (top != bar->top)
5161 mask |= CWY;
5162 if (sb_width != bar->width)
5163 mask |= CWWidth;
5164 if (height != bar->height)
5165 mask |= CWHeight;
5166
5167 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5168
5169 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5170 if (mask || bar->fringe_extended_p != fringe_extended_p)
5171 {
5172 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5173 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5174 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5175 {
5176 if (fringe_extended_p)
5177 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5178 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5179 else
5180 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5181 left, top, width, height, False);
5182 }
5183 #ifdef USE_GTK
5184 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5185 bar->x_window,
5186 top,
5187 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5188 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5189 max (height, 1));
5190 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5191 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5192 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5193 top,
5194 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5195 max (height, 1), 0);
5196 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5197 }
5198 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5199
5200 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5201 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5202 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5203 {
5204 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5205 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5206 height, False);
5207 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5208 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5209 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5210 height, False);
5211 }
5212
5213 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5214 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5215 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5216 example. */
5217 {
5218 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5219 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5220 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5221 {
5222 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5223 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5224 left + area_width - rest, top,
5225 rest, height, False);
5226 else
5227 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5228 left, top, rest, height, False);
5229 }
5230 }
5231
5232 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5233 if (mask)
5234 {
5235 XWindowChanges wc;
5236
5237 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5238 wc.y = top;
5239 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5240 wc.height = height;
5241 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5242 mask, &wc);
5243 }
5244
5245 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5246
5247 /* Remember new settings. */
5248 bar->left = sb_left;
5249 bar->top = top;
5250 bar->width = sb_width;
5251 bar->height = height;
5252
5253 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5254 }
5255
5256 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5257 bar->fringe_extended_p = fringe_extended_p;
5258
5259 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5260 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5261 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5262 dragged. */
5263 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5264 {
5265 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5266
5267 if (whole == 0)
5268 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5269 else
5270 {
5271 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5272 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5273 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5274 }
5275 }
5276 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5277
5278 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5279 }
5280
5281
5282 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5283 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5284 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5285 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5286 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5287 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5288 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5289
5290 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5291 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5292 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5293
5294 static void
5295 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (frame)
5296 FRAME_PTR frame;
5297 {
5298 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5299 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5300 {
5301 Lisp_Object bar;
5302 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5303 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5304 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5305 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5306 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5307 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5308 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5309 }
5310 }
5311
5312
5313 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5314 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5315
5316 static void
5317 XTredeem_scroll_bar (window)
5318 struct window *window;
5319 {
5320 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5321 struct frame *f;
5322
5323 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5324 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5325 abort ();
5326
5327 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5328
5329 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5330 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5331 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5332 {
5333 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5334 the lists. */
5335 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5336 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5337 return;
5338 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5339 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5340 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5341 else
5342 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5343 one or the other! */
5344 abort ();
5345 }
5346 else
5347 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5348
5349 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5350 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5351
5352 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5353 bar->prev = Qnil;
5354 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5355 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5356 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5357 }
5358
5359 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5360 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5361
5362 static void
5363 XTjudge_scroll_bars (f)
5364 FRAME_PTR f;
5365 {
5366 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5367
5368 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5369
5370 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5371 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5372 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5373
5374 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5375 {
5376 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5377
5378 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5379
5380 next = b->next;
5381 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5382 }
5383
5384 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5385 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5386 }
5387
5388
5389 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5390 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5391 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5392
5393 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5394 mark bits. */
5395
5396 static void
5397 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, event)
5398 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5399 XEvent *event;
5400 {
5401 Window w = bar->x_window;
5402 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5403 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5404 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5405
5406 BLOCK_INPUT;
5407
5408 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
5409
5410 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5411 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5412 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5413 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5414
5415 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5416 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5417
5418 /* x, y, width, height */
5419 0, 0,
5420 bar->width - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5421 bar->height - 1);
5422
5423 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5424 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5425 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5426 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5427
5428 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5429
5430 }
5431 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5432
5433 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5434 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5435
5436 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5437 mark bits. */
5438
5439
5440 static void
5441 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, event, emacs_event)
5442 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5443 XEvent *event;
5444 struct input_event *emacs_event;
5445 {
5446 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
5447 abort ();
5448
5449 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5450 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5451 emacs_event->modifiers
5452 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5453 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5454 event->xbutton.state)
5455 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5456 ? up_modifier
5457 : down_modifier));
5458 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5459 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5460 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5461 {
5462 int top_range
5463 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5464 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5465
5466 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5467 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5468
5469 if (y < bar->start)
5470 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5471 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5472 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5473 else
5474 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5475
5476 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5477 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5478 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5479 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5480 {
5481 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5482 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5483
5484 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5485 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5486 }
5487 #endif
5488
5489 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5490 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5491 }
5492 }
5493
5494 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5495
5496 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5497
5498 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5499 mark bits. */
5500
5501 static void
5502 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, event)
5503 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5504 XEvent *event;
5505 {
5506 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5507
5508 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5509
5510 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5511 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5512
5513 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5514 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5515 {
5516 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5517 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5518
5519 if (new_start != bar->start)
5520 {
5521 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5522
5523 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5524 }
5525 }
5526 }
5527
5528 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5529
5530 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5531 on the scroll bar. */
5532
5533 static void
5534 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
5535 FRAME_PTR *fp;
5536 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
5537 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
5538 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
5539 unsigned long *time;
5540 {
5541 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5542 Window w = bar->x_window;
5543 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5544 int win_x, win_y;
5545 Window dummy_window;
5546 int dummy_coord;
5547 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5548
5549 BLOCK_INPUT;
5550
5551 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5552 report that. */
5553 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5554
5555 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5556 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5557 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5558
5559 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5560 &win_x, &win_y,
5561
5562 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5563 &dummy_mask))
5564 ;
5565 else
5566 {
5567 int top_range
5568 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5569
5570 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5571
5572 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5573 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5574
5575 if (win_y < 0)
5576 win_y = 0;
5577 if (win_y > top_range)
5578 win_y = top_range;
5579
5580 *fp = f;
5581 *bar_window = bar->window;
5582
5583 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5584 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5585 else if (win_y < bar->start)
5586 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5587 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5588 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5589 else
5590 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5591
5592 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5593 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5594
5595 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5596 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5597 }
5598
5599 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
5600
5601 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5602 }
5603
5604
5605 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5606 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5607 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5608 redraw them. */
5609
5610 void
5611 x_scroll_bar_clear (f)
5612 FRAME_PTR f;
5613 {
5614 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5615 Lisp_Object bar;
5616
5617 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5618 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5619 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5620 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5621 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5622 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5623 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5624 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
5625 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5626 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5627 }
5628
5629 \f
5630 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5631
5632 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5633 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5634 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5635 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5636
5637 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5638 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5639
5640 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5641
5642 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5643 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5644
5645 static int temp_index;
5646 static short temp_buffer[100];
5647
5648 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5649 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5650 temp_index = 0; \
5651 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5652
5653 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5654 on a particular display. */
5655
5656 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5657
5658 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5659 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5660 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5661 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5662
5663 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5664
5665 #define SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT(size) \
5666 do \
5667 { \
5668 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5669 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5670 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5671 bcopy (&event, f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event, size); \
5672 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5673 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5674 } \
5675 while (0)
5676
5677 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XButtonEvent))
5678 #define SET_SAVED_KEY_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XKeyEvent))
5679
5680
5681 enum
5682 {
5683 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5684 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5685 X_EVENT_DROP
5686 };
5687
5688 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5689 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5690 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5691
5692 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5693 this event further.
5694 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5695
5696 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5697 static int
5698 x_filter_event (dpyinfo, event)
5699 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5700 XEvent *event;
5701 {
5702 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5703 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5704 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5705 was created. */
5706
5707 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5708 event->xclient.window);
5709
5710 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5711 }
5712 #endif
5713
5714 #ifdef USE_GTK
5715 static int current_count;
5716 static int current_finish;
5717 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5718
5719 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5720 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5721 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5722 static GdkFilterReturn
5723 event_handler_gdk (gxev, ev, data)
5724 GdkXEvent *gxev;
5725 GdkEvent *ev;
5726 gpointer data;
5727 {
5728 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5729
5730 if (current_count >= 0)
5731 {
5732 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5733
5734 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5735
5736 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5737 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5738 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5739 so we do it here. */
5740 if (xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5741 if (dpyinfo && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5742 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5743 #endif
5744
5745 if (! dpyinfo)
5746 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5747 else
5748 {
5749 current_count +=
5750 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5751 current_hold_quit);
5752 }
5753 }
5754 else
5755 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5756
5757 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5758 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5759
5760 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5761 }
5762 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5763
5764
5765 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5766
5767 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5768 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5769 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5770
5771 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5772
5773 static int
5774 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, eventp, finish, hold_quit)
5775 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5776 XEvent *eventp;
5777 int *finish;
5778 struct input_event *hold_quit;
5779 {
5780 union {
5781 struct input_event ie;
5782 struct selection_input_event sie;
5783 } inev;
5784 int count = 0;
5785 int do_help = 0;
5786 int nbytes = 0;
5787 struct frame *f = NULL;
5788 struct coding_system coding;
5789 XEvent event = *eventp;
5790
5791 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5792
5793 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5794 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5795 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5796
5797 switch (event.type)
5798 {
5799 case ClientMessage:
5800 {
5801 if (event.xclient.message_type
5802 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5803 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5804 {
5805 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5806 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5807 {
5808 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5809 could be the shell widget window
5810 if the frame has no title bar. */
5811 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5812 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5813 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5814 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5815 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5816 #endif
5817 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5818 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5819 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5820 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5821 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5822 needed.
5823
5824 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5825 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5826 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5827 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5828 Emacs. */
5829
5830 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5831 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5832 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5833 if (f)
5834 {
5835 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5836 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5837 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5838 x_catch_errors (d);
5839 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5840 /* The ICCCM says this is
5841 the only valid choice. */
5842 RevertToParent,
5843 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5844 /* This is needed to detect the error
5845 if there is an error. */
5846 XSync (d, False);
5847 x_uncatch_errors ();
5848 }
5849 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5850 #endif /* 0 */
5851 goto done;
5852 }
5853
5854 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5855 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5856 {
5857 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5858 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5859 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5860 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5861 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5862 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5863 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5864 session manager and one for this. */
5865 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5866 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5867 #endif
5868 {
5869 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5870 event.xclient.window);
5871 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5872 for a single Emacs process. */
5873 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5874 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5875 event.xclient.window,
5876 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5877 else if (f)
5878 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5879 event.xclient.window,
5880 0, 0);
5881 }
5882 goto done;
5883 }
5884
5885 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5886 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5887 {
5888 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5889 event.xclient.window);
5890 if (!f)
5891 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5892
5893 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5894 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5895 goto done;
5896 }
5897
5898 goto done;
5899 }
5900
5901 if (event.xclient.message_type
5902 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5903 {
5904 goto done;
5905 }
5906
5907 if (event.xclient.message_type
5908 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5909 {
5910 int new_x, new_y;
5911 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5912
5913 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5914 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5915
5916 if (f)
5917 {
5918 f->left_pos = new_x;
5919 f->top_pos = new_y;
5920 }
5921 goto done;
5922 }
5923
5924 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5925 if (event.xclient.message_type
5926 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
5927 {
5928 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5929 if (f)
5930 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
5931 &event, NULL);
5932 goto done;
5933 }
5934 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
5935
5936 if ((event.xclient.message_type
5937 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
5938 || (event.xclient.message_type
5939 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
5940 {
5941 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
5942 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
5943 currently never do because we are interested in
5944 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
5945 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
5946 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5947 if (!f)
5948 goto OTHER;
5949 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
5950 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
5951 goto done;
5952 }
5953
5954 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5955 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
5956 we construct an input_event. */
5957 if (event.xclient.message_type
5958 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
5959 {
5960 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
5961 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5962 goto done;
5963 }
5964 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5965
5966 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
5967 if (event.xclient.message_type
5968 == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
5969 {
5970 enum xembed_message msg = event.xclient.data.l[1];
5971 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
5972 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
5973
5974 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5975 goto done;
5976 }
5977
5978 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5979 if (!f)
5980 goto OTHER;
5981 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
5982 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
5983 }
5984 break;
5985
5986 case SelectionNotify:
5987 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
5988 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5989 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
5990 goto OTHER;
5991 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5992 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
5993 break;
5994
5995 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
5996 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
5997 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5998 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
5999 goto OTHER;
6000 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6001 {
6002 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
6003
6004 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
6005 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6006 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6007 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6008 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6009 }
6010 break;
6011
6012 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6013 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
6014 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6015 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
6016 goto OTHER;
6017 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6018 {
6019 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp
6020 = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
6021
6022 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
6023 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6024 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
6025 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6026 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
6027 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
6028 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6029 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6030 }
6031 break;
6032
6033 case PropertyNotify:
6034 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
6035 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window);
6036 if (f && event.xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
6037 x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event.xproperty);
6038
6039 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
6040 goto OTHER;
6041
6042 case ReparentNotify:
6043 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
6044 if (f)
6045 {
6046 int x, y;
6047 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
6048 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
6049 f->left_pos = x;
6050 f->top_pos = y;
6051
6052 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6053 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6054 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
6055 }
6056 goto OTHER;
6057
6058 case Expose:
6059 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
6060 if (f)
6061 {
6062 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6063
6064 #ifdef USE_GTK
6065 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6066 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
6067 event.xexpose.window,
6068 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6069 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
6070 FALSE);
6071 #endif
6072 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6073 {
6074 f->async_visible = 1;
6075 f->async_iconified = 0;
6076 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6077 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6078 }
6079 else
6080 expose_frame (f,
6081 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6082 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6083 }
6084 else
6085 {
6086 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6087 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6088 #endif
6089 #if defined USE_LUCID
6090 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6091 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6092 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6093 {
6094 Widget widget
6095 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6096 if (widget)
6097 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6098 }
6099 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6100
6101 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6102 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6103 goto OTHER;
6104 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6105 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6106 event.xexpose.window);
6107
6108 if (bar)
6109 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6110 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6111 else
6112 goto OTHER;
6113 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6114 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6115 }
6116 break;
6117
6118 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6119 source area was obscured or not
6120 available. */
6121 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6122 if (f)
6123 {
6124 expose_frame (f,
6125 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6126 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6127 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6128 }
6129 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6130 else
6131 goto OTHER;
6132 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6133 break;
6134
6135 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6136 source area was completely
6137 available. */
6138 break;
6139
6140 case UnmapNotify:
6141 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6142 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6143 {
6144 tip_window = 0;
6145 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6146 }
6147
6148 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6149 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6150 the frame was deleted. */
6151 {
6152 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6153 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6154 display that won't ever be seen. */
6155 f->async_visible = 0;
6156 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6157 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6158 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6159 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6160 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6161 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6162 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6163 {
6164 f->async_iconified = 1;
6165
6166 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6167 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6168 }
6169 }
6170 goto OTHER;
6171
6172 case MapNotify:
6173 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6174 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6175 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6176 goto OTHER;
6177
6178 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6179 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6180 frame is visible. */
6181 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6182 if (f)
6183 {
6184 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6185 the frame's display structures.
6186 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6187 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6188 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6189 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6190 if (! f->async_iconified)
6191 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6192
6193 f->async_visible = 1;
6194 f->async_iconified = 0;
6195 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6196
6197 if (f->iconified)
6198 {
6199 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6200 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6201 }
6202 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6203 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6204 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6205 to update the frame titles
6206 in case this is the second frame. */
6207 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6208 }
6209 goto OTHER;
6210
6211 case KeyPress:
6212
6213 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6214 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6215
6216 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6217 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6218 if (popup_activated ())
6219 goto OTHER;
6220 #endif
6221
6222 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6223
6224 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6225 mouse highlighting. */
6226 if (!dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6227 && (f == 0
6228 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, dpyinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6229 {
6230 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6231 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6232 }
6233
6234 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6235 if (f == 0)
6236 {
6237 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6238 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6239 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6240 event.xkey.window);
6241 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6242 {
6243 widget = XtParent (widget);
6244 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6245 }
6246 }
6247 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6248
6249 if (f != 0)
6250 {
6251 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6252 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6253 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6254 his Emacs hang.
6255
6256 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6257 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6258 status_return even if the input is too long to
6259 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6260 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6261 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6262 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6263 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6264 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6265 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6266 int modifiers;
6267 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6268 Lisp_Object c;
6269
6270 #ifdef USE_GTK
6271 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6272 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6273 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6274 (see above). */
6275 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6276 #endif
6277
6278 event.xkey.state
6279 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6280 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6281 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6282
6283 /* This will have to go some day... */
6284
6285 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6286 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6287 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6288 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6289 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6290 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6291 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6292
6293 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6294 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6295 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6296 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6297 not it is combined with Meta. */
6298 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6299 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6300
6301 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6302 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6303 {
6304 Status status_return;
6305
6306 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6307 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6308 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6309 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6310 &status_return);
6311 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6312 {
6313 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6314 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6315 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6316 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6317 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6318 &status_return);
6319 }
6320 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6321 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6322 break;
6323 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6324 {
6325 keysym = NoSymbol;
6326 modifiers = 0;
6327 }
6328 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6329 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6330 abort ();
6331 }
6332 else
6333 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6334 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6335 &compose_status);
6336 #else
6337 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6338 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6339 &compose_status);
6340 #endif
6341
6342 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6343 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6344 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6345 break;
6346
6347 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6348 orig_keysym = keysym;
6349
6350 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6351 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6352 inev.ie.modifiers
6353 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6354 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6355
6356 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6357 translations to characters. */
6358 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6359 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6360 {
6361 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6362 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6363 goto done_keysym;
6364 }
6365
6366 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6367 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
6368 {
6369 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
6370 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6371 else
6372 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6373 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
6374 goto done_keysym;
6375 }
6376
6377 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6378 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6379 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6380 Vx_keysym_table,
6381 Qnil))))
6382 {
6383 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6384 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6385 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6386 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6387 goto done_keysym;
6388 }
6389
6390 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6391 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6392 || keysym == XK_Delete
6393 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6394 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6395 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6396 #endif
6397 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6398 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6399 #ifdef HPUX
6400 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6401 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6402 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6403 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6404 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
6405 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
6406 #endif
6407 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6408 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6409 #endif
6410 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6411 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6412 #endif
6413 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6414 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6415 #endif
6416 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6417 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6418 #endif
6419 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6420 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6421 #endif
6422 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6423 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6424 #endif
6425 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6426 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6427 #endif
6428 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6429 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6430 #endif
6431 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6432 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6433 #endif
6434 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6435 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6436 #endif
6437 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6438 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6439 #endif
6440 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6441 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6442 #endif
6443 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6444 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6445 #endif
6446 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6447 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6448 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6449 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6450 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6451 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6452 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6453 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6454 don't have real modifiers but
6455 should be treated similarly to
6456 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6457 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6458 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6459 >= XK_ISO_Lock
6460 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6461 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6462 #endif
6463 ))
6464 {
6465 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6466 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6467 key. */
6468 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6469 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6470 goto done_keysym;
6471 }
6472
6473 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6474 register int i;
6475 register int c;
6476 int nchars, len;
6477
6478 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6479 {
6480 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
6481 nchars++;
6482 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6483 }
6484
6485 if (nchars < nbytes)
6486 {
6487 /* Decode the input data. */
6488 int require;
6489 unsigned char *p;
6490
6491 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6492 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6493 we used just above and the locale. */
6494 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6495 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6496 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6497 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6498 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6499 gives us composition information. */
6500 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
6501
6502 require = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
6503 coding.destination = alloca (require);
6504 coding.dst_bytes = require;
6505 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6506 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
6507 nbytes = coding.produced;
6508 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6509 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
6510 }
6511
6512 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6513 character events. */
6514 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6515 {
6516 if (nchars == nbytes)
6517 c = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6518 else
6519 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i,
6520 nbytes - i, len);
6521 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c)
6522 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6523 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6524 inev.ie.code = c;
6525 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6526 }
6527
6528 count += nchars;
6529
6530 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6531
6532 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6533 break;
6534 }
6535 }
6536 done_keysym:
6537 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6538 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6539 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6540 client. */
6541 break;
6542 #else
6543 goto OTHER;
6544 #endif
6545
6546 case KeyRelease:
6547 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6548 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6549 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6550 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6551 client. */
6552 break;
6553 #else
6554 goto OTHER;
6555 #endif
6556
6557 case EnterNotify:
6558 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6559 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6560
6561 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6562
6563 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6564 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6565
6566 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6567 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6568 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6569 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6570 #ifdef USE_GTK
6571 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6572 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6573 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6574 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6575 #endif
6576 goto OTHER;
6577
6578 case FocusIn:
6579 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6580 goto OTHER;
6581
6582 case LeaveNotify:
6583 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6584 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6585
6586 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6587 if (f)
6588 {
6589 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6590 {
6591 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6592 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6593 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6594 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6595 }
6596
6597 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6598 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6599 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6600 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6601 if (any_help_event_p)
6602 do_help = -1;
6603 }
6604 #ifdef USE_GTK
6605 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6606 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6607 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6608 #endif
6609 goto OTHER;
6610
6611 case FocusOut:
6612 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6613 goto OTHER;
6614
6615 case MotionNotify:
6616 {
6617 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6618 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6619 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6620
6621 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6622 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6623 f = last_mouse_frame;
6624 else
6625 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6626
6627 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6628 {
6629 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6630 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6631 }
6632
6633 if (f)
6634 {
6635
6636 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6637 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6638 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
6639 {
6640 Lisp_Object window;
6641
6642 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6643 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6644 0, 0, 0, 0);
6645
6646 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6647 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6648 will be selected only when it is active. */
6649 if (WINDOWP (window)
6650 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6651 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6652 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6653 create event iff we don't leave the
6654 selected frame. */
6655 && (focus_follows_mouse
6656 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
6657 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
6658 {
6659 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6660 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6661 }
6662
6663 last_window=window;
6664 }
6665 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6666 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6667 }
6668 else
6669 {
6670 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6671 struct scroll_bar *bar
6672 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6673 event.xmotion.window);
6674
6675 if (bar)
6676 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6677 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6678
6679 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6680 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6681 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6682 }
6683
6684 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6685 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6686 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6687 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6688 do_help = 1;
6689 goto OTHER;
6690 }
6691
6692 case ConfigureNotify:
6693 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6694 #ifdef USE_GTK
6695 if (!f
6696 && (f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window))
6697 && event.xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
6698 {
6699 xg_frame_resized (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6700 event.xconfigure.height);
6701 f = 0;
6702 }
6703 #endif
6704 if (f)
6705 {
6706 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6707 #ifndef USE_GTK
6708 /* If there is a pending resize for fullscreen, don't
6709 do this one, the right one will come later.
6710 The toolkit version doesn't seem to need this, but we
6711 need to reset it below. */
6712 int dont_resize
6713 = ((f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6714 && f->new_text_cols != 0);
6715 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6716 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6717
6718 if (dont_resize)
6719 goto OTHER;
6720
6721 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6722 is called by the code that handles resizing
6723 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6724
6725 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6726 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6727 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6728 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6729 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6730 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6731 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6732 {
6733 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6734 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6735 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6736 }
6737
6738 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6739 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6740 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6741 #endif
6742
6743 #ifdef USE_GTK
6744 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6745 Only get real positions and check fullscreen when mapped. */
6746 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6747 && GTK_WIDGET_MAPPED (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6748 #endif
6749 {
6750 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6751
6752 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6753 f->want_fullscreen &= ~(FULLSCREEN_WAIT|FULLSCREEN_BOTH);
6754 }
6755
6756 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6757 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6758 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6759 #endif
6760
6761 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
6762 {
6763 /* Since the WM decorations come below top_pos now,
6764 we must put them below top_pos in the future. */
6765 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
6766 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
6767 }
6768 }
6769 goto OTHER;
6770
6771 case ButtonRelease:
6772 case ButtonPress:
6773 {
6774 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6775 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6776 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6777
6778 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6779 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6780 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6781
6782 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6783 && last_mouse_frame
6784 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6785 f = last_mouse_frame;
6786 else
6787 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6788
6789 if (f)
6790 {
6791 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6792 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6793 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6794 {
6795 Lisp_Object window;
6796 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6797 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6798
6799 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 0, 0, 1);
6800 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
6801
6802 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6803 {
6804 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y,
6805 event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
6806 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6807 event.xbutton.state));
6808 }
6809 }
6810
6811 if (!tool_bar_p)
6812 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6813 if (! popup_activated ())
6814 #endif
6815 {
6816 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6817 {
6818 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6819 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6820 {
6821 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6822 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6823 }
6824 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6825 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6826 }
6827 else
6828 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6829 }
6830 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
6831 xembed_send_message (f, event.xbutton.time,
6832 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
6833 }
6834 else
6835 {
6836 struct scroll_bar *bar
6837 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6838 event.xbutton.window);
6839
6840 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6841 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6842 scroll bars. */
6843 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6844 {
6845 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6846 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6847 }
6848 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6849 if (bar)
6850 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6851 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6852 }
6853
6854 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6855 {
6856 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6857 last_mouse_frame = f;
6858
6859 if (!tool_bar_p)
6860 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6861 }
6862 else
6863 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6864
6865 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6866 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6867 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6868 if (f != 0)
6869 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6870
6871 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6872 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6873 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6874 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6875 Instead, save it away
6876 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6877 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6878 if (
6879 #ifdef USE_GTK
6880 ! popup_activated ()
6881 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
6882 && event.xbutton.button < 3
6883 &&
6884 #endif
6885 f && event.type == ButtonPress
6886 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6887 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6888 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6889 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6890 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6891 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6892 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6893 {
6894 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6895 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6896 #ifdef USE_GTK
6897 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6898 #endif
6899 }
6900 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6901 {
6902 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6903 goto OTHER;
6904 }
6905
6906 #ifdef USE_MOTIF /* This should do not harm for Lucid,
6907 but I am trying to be cautious. */
6908 else if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6909 {
6910 if (!NILP (last_mouse_press_frame))
6911 {
6912 f = XFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame);
6913 if (f->output_data.x)
6914 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6915 }
6916 else
6917 goto OTHER;
6918 }
6919 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
6920 else
6921 goto OTHER;
6922 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6923 }
6924 break;
6925
6926 case CirculateNotify:
6927 goto OTHER;
6928
6929 case CirculateRequest:
6930 goto OTHER;
6931
6932 case VisibilityNotify:
6933 goto OTHER;
6934
6935 case MappingNotify:
6936 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6937 local cache. */
6938 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6939 {
6940 case MappingModifier:
6941 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6942 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6943 case MappingKeyboard:
6944 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6945 }
6946 goto OTHER;
6947
6948 default:
6949 OTHER:
6950 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6951 BLOCK_INPUT;
6952 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
6953 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
6954 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6955 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6956 break;
6957 }
6958
6959 done:
6960 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
6961 {
6962 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6963 count++;
6964 }
6965
6966 if (do_help
6967 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
6968 {
6969 Lisp_Object frame;
6970
6971 if (f)
6972 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
6973 else
6974 frame = Qnil;
6975
6976 if (do_help > 0)
6977 {
6978 any_help_event_p = 1;
6979 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
6980 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
6981 }
6982 else
6983 {
6984 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6985 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
6986 }
6987 count++;
6988 }
6989
6990 *eventp = event;
6991 return count;
6992 }
6993
6994
6995 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
6996 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
6997 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
6998
6999 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
7000 int
7001 x_dispatch_event (event, display)
7002 XEvent *event;
7003 Display *display;
7004 {
7005 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7006 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
7007
7008 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
7009
7010 if (dpyinfo)
7011 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
7012
7013 return finish;
7014 }
7015
7016
7017 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7018 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
7019 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7020
7021 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7022 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7023 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7024 C chars).
7025
7026 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
7027
7028 static int
7029 XTread_socket (terminal, expected, hold_quit)
7030 struct terminal *terminal;
7031 int expected;
7032 struct input_event *hold_quit;
7033 {
7034 int count = 0;
7035 XEvent event;
7036 int event_found = 0;
7037
7038 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
7039 {
7040 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
7041 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7042 pending_signals = 1;
7043 #endif
7044 return -1;
7045 }
7046
7047 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
7048 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7049 pending_signals = pending_atimers;
7050 #endif
7051 BLOCK_INPUT;
7052
7053 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7054 input_signal_count++;
7055
7056 ++handling_signal;
7057
7058 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
7059 /* Only check session manager input for the primary display. */
7060 if (terminal->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
7061 {
7062 struct input_event inev;
7063 BLOCK_INPUT;
7064 /* We don't need to EVENT_INIT (inev) here, as
7065 x_session_check_input copies an entire input_event. */
7066 if (x_session_check_input (&inev))
7067 {
7068 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
7069 count++;
7070 }
7071 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7072 }
7073 #endif
7074
7075 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7076 if (terminal->display_info.x == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7077 {
7078 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7079 x_io_error_quitter (terminal->display_info.x->display);
7080 }
7081
7082 #ifndef USE_GTK
7083 while (XPending (terminal->display_info.x->display))
7084 {
7085 int finish;
7086
7087 XNextEvent (terminal->display_info.x->display, &event);
7088
7089 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7090 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7091 if (x_filter_event (terminal->display_info.x, &event))
7092 break;
7093 #endif
7094 event_found = 1;
7095
7096 count += handle_one_xevent (terminal->display_info.x,
7097 &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7098
7099 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7100 goto out;
7101 }
7102
7103 #else /* USE_GTK */
7104
7105 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7106 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7107 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7108 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7109
7110 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7111 from all displays. */
7112
7113 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7114 {
7115 current_count = count;
7116 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7117
7118 gtk_main_iteration ();
7119
7120 count = current_count;
7121 current_count = -1;
7122 current_hold_quit = 0;
7123
7124 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7125 break;
7126 }
7127 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7128
7129 out:;
7130
7131 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7132 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7133 if (! event_found)
7134 {
7135 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7136 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7137 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7138 x_noop_count++;
7139 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7140 {
7141 x_noop_count=0;
7142
7143 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7144 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7145
7146 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7147
7148 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7149 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7150 }
7151 }
7152
7153 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7154 raise it now. */
7155 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7156 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7157 {
7158 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7159 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7160 }
7161
7162 --handling_signal;
7163 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7164
7165 return count;
7166 }
7167
7168
7169
7170 \f
7171 /***********************************************************************
7172 Text Cursor
7173 ***********************************************************************/
7174
7175 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7176 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7177
7178 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7179 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7180 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7181
7182 static void
7183 x_clip_to_row (w, row, area, gc)
7184 struct window *w;
7185 struct glyph_row *row;
7186 int area;
7187 GC gc;
7188 {
7189 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7190 XRectangle clip_rect;
7191 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7192
7193 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7194
7195 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7196 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7197 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7198 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7199 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7200
7201 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7202 }
7203
7204
7205 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7206
7207 static void
7208 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, row)
7209 struct window *w;
7210 struct glyph_row *row;
7211 {
7212 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7213 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7214 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7215 int x, y, wd, h;
7216 XGCValues xgcv;
7217 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7218 GC gc;
7219
7220 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7221 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7222 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7223 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7224 return;
7225
7226 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7227 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7228 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7229
7230 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7231 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7232 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7233 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7234 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7235 else
7236 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7237 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7238 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7239
7240 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7241 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7242 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7243 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7244 }
7245
7246
7247 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7248
7249 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7250 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7251 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7252 --gerd. */
7253
7254 static void
7255 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, row, width, kind)
7256 struct window *w;
7257 struct glyph_row *row;
7258 int width;
7259 enum text_cursor_kinds kind;
7260 {
7261 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7262 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7263
7264 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7265 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7266 and mini-buffer. */
7267 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7268 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7269 return;
7270
7271 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7272 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7273 the bar might not be in the window. */
7274 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7275 {
7276 struct glyph_row *row;
7277 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7278 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7279 }
7280 else
7281 {
7282 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7283 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7284 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7285 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7286 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7287 XGCValues xgcv;
7288
7289 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7290 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7291 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7292 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7293 that the glyph is legible. */
7294 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7295 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7296 else
7297 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7298 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7299
7300 if (gc)
7301 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7302 else
7303 {
7304 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7305 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7306 }
7307
7308 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7309
7310 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7311 {
7312 if (width < 0)
7313 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7314 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7315
7316 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7317
7318 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7319 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7320 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7321 width, row->height);
7322 }
7323 else
7324 {
7325 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
7326
7327 if (width < 0)
7328 width = row->height;
7329
7330 width = min (row->height, width);
7331
7332 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
7333 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
7334
7335 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7336 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7337 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7338 row->height - width),
7339 w->phys_cursor_width, width);
7340 }
7341
7342 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7343 }
7344 }
7345
7346
7347 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7348
7349 static void
7350 x_define_frame_cursor (f, cursor)
7351 struct frame *f;
7352 Cursor cursor;
7353 {
7354 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7355 }
7356
7357
7358 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7359
7360 static void
7361 x_clear_frame_area (f, x, y, width, height)
7362 struct frame *f;
7363 int x, y, width, height;
7364 {
7365 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7366 x, y, width, height, False);
7367 }
7368
7369
7370 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7371
7372 static void
7373 x_draw_window_cursor (w, glyph_row, x, y, cursor_type, cursor_width, on_p, active_p)
7374 struct window *w;
7375 struct glyph_row *glyph_row;
7376 int x, y;
7377 int cursor_type, cursor_width;
7378 int on_p, active_p;
7379 {
7380 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7381
7382 if (on_p)
7383 {
7384 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7385 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7386
7387 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7388 && w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
7389 {
7390 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7391 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, 0);
7392 }
7393 else
7394 switch (cursor_type)
7395 {
7396 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7397 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7398 break;
7399
7400 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7401 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7402 break;
7403
7404 case BAR_CURSOR:
7405 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7406 break;
7407
7408 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7409 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7410 break;
7411
7412 case NO_CURSOR:
7413 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7414 break;
7415
7416 default:
7417 abort ();
7418 }
7419
7420 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7421 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7422 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7423 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7424 #endif
7425 }
7426
7427 #ifndef XFlush
7428 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7429 #endif
7430 }
7431
7432 \f
7433 /* Icons. */
7434
7435 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7436
7437 int
7438 x_bitmap_icon (f, file)
7439 struct frame *f;
7440 Lisp_Object file;
7441 {
7442 int bitmap_id;
7443
7444 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7445 return 1;
7446
7447 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7448 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7449 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7450 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7451
7452 if (STRINGP (file))
7453 {
7454 #ifdef USE_GTK
7455 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7456 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7457 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7458 return 0;
7459 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7460 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7461 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7462 }
7463 else
7464 {
7465 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7466 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7467 {
7468 int rc = -1;
7469
7470 #ifdef USE_GTK
7471
7472 if (xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
7473 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7474 return 0;
7475
7476 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7477
7478 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7479 if (rc != -1)
7480 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7481
7482 #endif
7483
7484 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7485 if (rc == -1)
7486 {
7487 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, gnu_xbm_bits,
7488 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7489 if (rc == -1)
7490 return 1;
7491
7492 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7493 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7494 }
7495 }
7496
7497 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7498 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7499 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7500 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7501 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7502
7503 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7504 }
7505
7506 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7507 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7508
7509 return 0;
7510 }
7511
7512
7513 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7514 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7515
7516 int
7517 x_text_icon (f, icon_name)
7518 struct frame *f;
7519 char *icon_name;
7520 {
7521 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7522 return 1;
7523
7524 {
7525 XTextProperty text;
7526 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7527 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7528 text.format = 8;
7529 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7530 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7531 }
7532
7533 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7534 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7535 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7536 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7537
7538 return 0;
7539 }
7540 \f
7541 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7542
7543 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7544 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7545
7546 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7547 be called from a signal handler.
7548 */
7549
7550 struct x_error_message_stack {
7551 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7552 Display *dpy;
7553 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7554 };
7555 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7556
7557 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7558 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7559 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7560
7561 static void
7562 x_error_catcher (display, error)
7563 Display *display;
7564 XErrorEvent *error;
7565 {
7566 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code,
7567 x_error_message->string,
7568 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7569 }
7570
7571 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7572 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7573 operating on.
7574
7575 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7576 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7577 stored in *x_error_message.
7578
7579 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7580 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7581
7582 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7583
7584 void x_check_errors ();
7585
7586 void
7587 x_catch_errors (dpy)
7588 Display *dpy;
7589 {
7590 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof (*data));
7591
7592 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7593 XSync (dpy, False);
7594
7595 data->dpy = dpy;
7596 data->string[0] = 0;
7597 data->prev = x_error_message;
7598 x_error_message = data;
7599 }
7600
7601 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7602 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7603
7604 void
7605 x_uncatch_errors ()
7606 {
7607 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7608
7609 BLOCK_INPUT;
7610
7611 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7612 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7613 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7614 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7615
7616 tmp = x_error_message;
7617 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7618 xfree (tmp);
7619 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7620 }
7621
7622 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7623 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7624 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7625
7626 void
7627 x_check_errors (dpy, format)
7628 Display *dpy;
7629 char *format;
7630 {
7631 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7632 XSync (dpy, False);
7633
7634 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7635 {
7636 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7637 bcopy (x_error_message->string, string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7638 x_uncatch_errors ();
7639 error (format, string);
7640 }
7641 }
7642
7643 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7644 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7645
7646 int
7647 x_had_errors_p (dpy)
7648 Display *dpy;
7649 {
7650 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7651 XSync (dpy, False);
7652
7653 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7654 }
7655
7656 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7657
7658 void
7659 x_clear_errors (dpy)
7660 Display *dpy;
7661 {
7662 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7663 }
7664
7665 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7666 * idea. --lorentey */
7667 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7668
7669 void
7670 x_fully_uncatch_errors ()
7671 {
7672 while (x_error_message)
7673 x_uncatch_errors ();
7674 }
7675 #endif
7676
7677 /* Nonzero if x_catch_errors has been done and not yet canceled. */
7678
7679 int
7680 x_catching_errors ()
7681 {
7682 return x_error_message != 0;
7683 }
7684
7685 #if 0
7686 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7687 x_trace_wire ()
7688 {
7689 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7690 }
7691 #endif /* ! 0 */
7692
7693 \f
7694 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7695 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7696 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7697 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7698 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7699
7700 static SIGTYPE
7701 x_connection_signal (signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7702 int signalnum; /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7703 {
7704 #ifdef USG
7705 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7706 must reestablish each time */
7707 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7708 #endif /* USG */
7709 }
7710
7711 \f
7712 /************************************************************************
7713 Handling X errors
7714 ************************************************************************/
7715
7716 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7717
7718 static char *error_msg;
7719
7720 /* Function installed as fatal_error_signal_hook in
7721 x_connection_closed. Print the X error message, and exit normally,
7722 instead of dumping core when XtCloseDisplay fails. */
7723
7724 static void
7725 x_fatal_error_signal ()
7726 {
7727 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7728 exit (70);
7729 }
7730
7731 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7732 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7733
7734 static SIGTYPE
7735 x_connection_closed (dpy, error_message)
7736 Display *dpy;
7737 char *error_message;
7738 {
7739 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7740 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7741 int index = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7742
7743 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7744 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7745 handling_signal = 0;
7746
7747 /* Prevent being called recursively because of an error condition
7748 below. Otherwise, we might end up with printing ``can't find per
7749 display information'' in the recursive call instead of printing
7750 the original message here. */
7751 x_catch_errors (dpy);
7752
7753 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7754 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
7755
7756 if (dpyinfo)
7757 {
7758 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7759 frame on it. */
7760 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
7761 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
7762 }
7763
7764 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7765 that are on the dead display. */
7766 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7767 {
7768 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7769 minibuf_frame
7770 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7771 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7772 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7773 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7774 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7775 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7776 }
7777
7778 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7779 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7780 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7781 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7782 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7783 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7784 {
7785 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7786 trying to find a replacement. */
7787 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame = Qt;
7788 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7789 }
7790
7791 /* We have to close the display to inform Xt that it doesn't
7792 exist anymore. If we don't, Xt will continue to wait for
7793 events from the display. As a consequence, a sequence of
7794
7795 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7796 ...kill the new frame, so that we get an IO error...
7797 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7798
7799 will indefinitely wait in Xt for events for display `:1', opened
7800 in the first call to make-frame-on-display.
7801
7802 Closing the display is reported to lead to a bus error on
7803 OpenWindows in certain situations. I suspect that is a bug
7804 in OpenWindows. I don't know how to circumvent it here. */
7805
7806 if (dpyinfo)
7807 {
7808 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7809 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display
7810 in the first place, so don't try to close it. */
7811 {
7812 extern void (*fatal_error_signal_hook) P_ ((void));
7813 fatal_error_signal_hook = x_fatal_error_signal;
7814 XtCloseDisplay (dpy);
7815 fatal_error_signal_hook = NULL;
7816 }
7817 #endif
7818
7819 #ifdef USE_GTK
7820 /* Due to bugs in some Gtk+ versions, just exit here if this
7821 is the last display/terminal. */
7822 if (terminal_list->next_terminal == NULL)
7823 {
7824 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7825 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7826 exit (70);
7827 }
7828 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
7829 #endif
7830
7831 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7832 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7833
7834 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
7835 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
7836 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
7837 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7838 abort ();
7839
7840 {
7841 Lisp_Object tmp;
7842 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
7843 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
7844 }
7845 }
7846
7847 x_uncatch_errors ();
7848
7849 if (terminal_list == 0)
7850 {
7851 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7852 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7853 exit (70);
7854 }
7855
7856 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7857 #ifdef SIGIO
7858 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7859 #endif
7860 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7861 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7862
7863 unbind_to (index, Qnil);
7864 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7865 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7866 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7867 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7868 error ("%s", error_msg);
7869 }
7870
7871 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7872 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7873 static void x_error_quitter P_ ((Display *, XErrorEvent *));
7874
7875 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7876 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7877
7878 static int
7879 x_error_handler (display, error)
7880 Display *display;
7881 XErrorEvent *error;
7882 {
7883 if (x_error_message)
7884 x_error_catcher (display, error);
7885 else
7886 x_error_quitter (display, error);
7887 return 0;
7888 }
7889
7890 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7891 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7892 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7893
7894 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7895
7896 #if __GNUC__ >= 3 /* On GCC 3.0 we might get a warning. */
7897 #define NO_INLINE __attribute__((noinline))
7898 #else
7899 #define NO_INLINE
7900 #endif
7901
7902 /* Some versions of GNU/Linux define noinline in their headers. */
7903
7904 #ifdef noinline
7905 #undef noinline
7906 #endif
7907
7908 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7909 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7910
7911 static void NO_INLINE
7912 x_error_quitter (display, error)
7913 Display *display;
7914 XErrorEvent *error;
7915 {
7916 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7917
7918 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7919 or colors that are not defined. */
7920
7921 if (error->error_code == BadName)
7922 return;
7923
7924 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7925 original error handler. */
7926
7927 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7928 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7929 buf, error->request_code);
7930 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7931 }
7932
7933
7934 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7935 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7936 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7937
7938 static int
7939 x_io_error_quitter (display)
7940 Display *display;
7941 {
7942 char buf[256];
7943
7944 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
7945 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7946 return 0;
7947 }
7948 \f
7949 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7950
7951 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
7952 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
7953 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
7954 FONT-OBJECT. */
7955
7956 Lisp_Object
7957 x_new_font (f, font_object, fontset)
7958 struct frame *f;
7959 Lisp_Object font_object;
7960 int fontset;
7961 {
7962 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
7963
7964 if (fontset < 0)
7965 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
7966 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7967 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
7968 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
7969 do. */
7970 return font_object;
7971
7972 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
7973 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
7974 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
7975 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = font->space_width;
7976 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
7977
7978 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7979
7980 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7981 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7982 {
7983 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7984 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7985 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7986 }
7987 else
7988 {
7989 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7990 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7991 }
7992
7993 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7994 {
7995 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7996 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7997 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7998 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7999 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
8000 }
8001
8002 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8003 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
8004 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
8005 {
8006 BLOCK_INPUT;
8007 xic_set_xfontset (f, SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
8008 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8009 }
8010 #endif
8011
8012 return font_object;
8013 }
8014
8015 \f
8016 /***********************************************************************
8017 X Input Methods
8018 ***********************************************************************/
8019
8020 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8021
8022 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8023
8024 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
8025 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
8026 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
8027
8028 static void
8029 xim_destroy_callback (xim, client_data, call_data)
8030 XIM xim;
8031 XPointer client_data;
8032 XPointer call_data;
8033 {
8034 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
8035 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
8036
8037 BLOCK_INPUT;
8038
8039 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
8040 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8041 {
8042 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8043 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
8044 {
8045 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
8046 xic_free_xfontset (f);
8047 }
8048 }
8049
8050 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
8051 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8052 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8053 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8054 }
8055
8056 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
8057
8058 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8059 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
8060 extern char *XSetIMValues P_ ((XIM, ...));
8061 #endif
8062
8063 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8064 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8065
8066 static void
8067 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name)
8068 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8069 char *resource_name;
8070 {
8071 XIM xim;
8072
8073 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8074 if (use_xim)
8075 {
8076 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8077 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8078 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8079 EMACS_CLASS);
8080 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8081
8082 if (xim)
8083 {
8084 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8085 XIMCallback destroy;
8086 #endif
8087
8088 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8089 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8090
8091 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8092 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8093 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8094 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8095 #endif
8096 }
8097 }
8098
8099 else
8100 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8101 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8102 }
8103
8104
8105 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8106
8107 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8108 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8109 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8110 when the callback was registered. */
8111
8112 static void
8113 xim_instantiate_callback (display, client_data, call_data)
8114 Display *display;
8115 XPointer client_data;
8116 XPointer call_data;
8117 {
8118 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8119 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8120
8121 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8122 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8123 return;
8124
8125 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8126
8127 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8128 as they have no XIC. */
8129 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8130 {
8131 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8132
8133 BLOCK_INPUT;
8134 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8135 {
8136 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8137
8138 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
8139 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8140 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8141 {
8142 create_frame_xic (f);
8143 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8144 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8145 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8146 {
8147 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8148 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8149 }
8150 }
8151 }
8152
8153 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8154 }
8155 }
8156
8157 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8158
8159
8160 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8161 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8162 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8163 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8164
8165 static void
8166 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name)
8167 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8168 char *resource_name;
8169 {
8170 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8171 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8172 if (use_xim)
8173 {
8174 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8175 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8176 int len;
8177
8178 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8179 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
8180 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8181 len = strlen (resource_name);
8182 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8183 bcopy (resource_name, xim_inst->resource_name, len + 1);
8184 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8185 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
8186 xim_instantiate_callback,
8187 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8188 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8189 least, hence the configure test. */
8190 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8191 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8192 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8193 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8194 }
8195 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8196 }
8197
8198
8199 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8200
8201 static void
8202 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo)
8203 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8204 {
8205 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8206 if (use_xim)
8207 {
8208 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8209 if (dpyinfo->display)
8210 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8211 NULL, EMACS_CLASS,
8212 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8213 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data->resource_name);
8214 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data);
8215 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8216 if (dpyinfo->display)
8217 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8218 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8219 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8220 }
8221 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8222 }
8223
8224 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8225
8226
8227 \f
8228 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8229 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8230
8231 void
8232 x_calc_absolute_position (f)
8233 struct frame *f;
8234 {
8235 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8236
8237 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8238 is already for the top-left corner. */
8239 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8240 return;
8241
8242 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8243 position that fits on the screen. */
8244 if (flags & XNegative)
8245 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8246 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
8247
8248 {
8249 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8250
8251 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8252 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8253 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8254
8255 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8256 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8257 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8258 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8259 is right, though.
8260
8261 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8262 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8263
8264 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8265 #endif
8266
8267 if (flags & YNegative)
8268 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8269 - height + f->top_pos;
8270 }
8271
8272 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8273 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8274 so the flags should correspond. */
8275 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8276 }
8277
8278 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8279 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8280 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8281 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8282 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8283
8284 void
8285 x_set_offset (f, xoff, yoff, change_gravity)
8286 struct frame *f;
8287 register int xoff, yoff;
8288 int change_gravity;
8289 {
8290 int modified_top, modified_left;
8291
8292 if (change_gravity > 0)
8293 {
8294 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8295 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8296
8297 f->top_pos = yoff;
8298 f->left_pos = xoff;
8299 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8300 if (xoff < 0)
8301 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8302 if (yoff < 0)
8303 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8304 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8305 }
8306 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8307
8308 BLOCK_INPUT;
8309 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8310
8311 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8312 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8313
8314 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8315 {
8316 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8317 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8318 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8319 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8320 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8321 }
8322
8323 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8324 modified_left, modified_top);
8325
8326 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8327 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8328 ? 1 : 0);
8329
8330 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8331 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8332 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8333 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8334 of the frame.
8335
8336 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8337 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8338 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8339
8340 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8341 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8342 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8343 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8344 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8345 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8346
8347 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8348 }
8349
8350 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8351 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8352 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8353 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8354 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8355
8356 static int
8357 wm_supports (f, atomname)
8358 struct frame *f;
8359 const char *atomname;
8360 {
8361 Atom actual_type;
8362 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8363 int i, rc, actual_format;
8364 Atom prop_atom;
8365 Window wmcheck_window;
8366 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8367 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8368 long max_len = 65536;
8369 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8370 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8371 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8372 Atom want_atom;
8373
8374 BLOCK_INPUT;
8375
8376 prop_atom = XInternAtom (dpy, "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", False);
8377
8378 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8379 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8380 prop_atom, 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8381 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8382 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8383
8384 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8385 {
8386 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8387 x_uncatch_errors ();
8388 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8389 return 0;
8390 }
8391
8392 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8393 XFree (tmp_data);
8394
8395 /* Check if window exists. */
8396 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8397 x_sync (f);
8398 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8399 {
8400 x_uncatch_errors ();
8401 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8402 return 0;
8403 }
8404
8405 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8406 {
8407 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8408 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8409 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8410 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8411 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8412 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8413
8414 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8415 prop_atom = XInternAtom (dpy, "_NET_SUPPORTED", False);
8416 tmp_data = NULL;
8417 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8418 prop_atom, 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8419 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8420 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8421
8422 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8423 {
8424 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8425 x_uncatch_errors ();
8426 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8427 return 0;
8428 }
8429
8430 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8431 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8432 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8433 }
8434
8435 rc = 0;
8436 want_atom = XInternAtom (dpy, atomname, False);
8437
8438 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8439 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8440
8441 x_uncatch_errors ();
8442 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8443
8444 return rc;
8445 }
8446
8447 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8448
8449 static int
8450 do_ewmh_fullscreen (f)
8451 struct frame *f;
8452 {
8453 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, "_NET_WM_STATE");
8454
8455 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8456 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8457 if (!have_net_atom)
8458 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN");
8459
8460 if (have_net_atom)
8461 {
8462 Lisp_Object frame;
8463 const char *atom = "_NET_WM_STATE";
8464 const char *fs = "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN";
8465 const char *fw = "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ";
8466 const char *fh = "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT";
8467 const char *what = NULL;
8468
8469 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8470
8471 /* If there are _NET_ atoms we assume we have extended window manager
8472 hints. */
8473 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8474 {
8475 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8476 what = fs;
8477 break;
8478 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8479 what = fw;
8480 break;
8481 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8482 what = fh;
8483 break;
8484 }
8485
8486 if (what != NULL && !wm_supports (f, what)) return 0;
8487
8488
8489 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8490 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8491 make_number (32),
8492 Fcons (make_number (0), /* Remove */
8493 Fcons
8494 (make_unibyte_string (fs,
8495 strlen (fs)),
8496 Qnil)));
8497 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8498 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8499 make_number (32),
8500 Fcons (make_number (0), /* Remove */
8501 Fcons
8502 (make_unibyte_string (fh,
8503 strlen (fh)),
8504 Qnil)));
8505 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8506 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8507 make_number (32),
8508 Fcons (make_number (0), /* Remove */
8509 Fcons
8510 (make_unibyte_string (fw,
8511 strlen (fw)),
8512 Qnil)));
8513 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8514 if (what != NULL)
8515 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8516 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8517 make_number (32),
8518 Fcons (make_number (1), /* Add */
8519 Fcons
8520 (make_unibyte_string (what,
8521 strlen (what)),
8522 Qnil)));
8523 }
8524
8525 return have_net_atom;
8526 }
8527
8528 static void
8529 XTfullscreen_hook (f)
8530 FRAME_PTR f;
8531 {
8532 if (f->async_visible)
8533 {
8534 BLOCK_INPUT;
8535 do_ewmh_fullscreen (f);
8536 x_sync (f);
8537 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8538 }
8539 }
8540
8541
8542 extern Lisp_Object Qfullwidth, Qfullheight, Qfullboth;
8543 static void
8544 x_handle_net_wm_state (f, event)
8545 struct frame *f;
8546 XPropertyEvent *event;
8547 {
8548 Atom actual_type;
8549 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8550 int i, rc, actual_format, value = 0;
8551 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8552 long max_len = 65536;
8553 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8554 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8555 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
8556 Lisp_Object lval;
8557
8558 BLOCK_INPUT;
8559 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8560 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, event->window,
8561 event->atom, 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8562 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8563 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8564
8565 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8566 {
8567 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8568 x_uncatch_errors ();
8569 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8570 return;
8571 }
8572
8573 x_uncatch_errors ();
8574
8575 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
8576 {
8577 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
8578 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
8579 value |= FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
8580 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
8581 value |= FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
8582 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen_atom)
8583 value |= FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
8584 }
8585
8586 lval = Qnil;
8587 switch (value)
8588 {
8589 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8590 lval = Qfullwidth;
8591 break;
8592 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8593 lval = Qfullheight;
8594 break;
8595 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8596 lval = Qfullboth;
8597 break;
8598 }
8599
8600 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
8601
8602 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8603 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8604 }
8605
8606 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8607 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8608 static void
8609 x_check_fullscreen (f)
8610 struct frame *f;
8611 {
8612 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8613 {
8614 int width, height, ign;
8615
8616 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8617 return;
8618
8619 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
8620
8621 x_fullscreen_adjust (f, &width, &height, &ign, &ign);
8622
8623 /* We do not need to move the window, it shall be taken care of
8624 when setting WM manager hints.
8625 If the frame is visible already, the position is checked by
8626 x_check_expected_move. */
8627 if (FRAME_COLS (f) != width || FRAME_LINES (f) != height)
8628 {
8629 change_frame_size (f, height, width, 0, 1, 0);
8630 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8631 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8632
8633 /* Wait for the change of frame size to occur */
8634 f->want_fullscreen |= FULLSCREEN_WAIT;
8635 }
8636 }
8637 }
8638
8639 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8640 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8641 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8642 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8643 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8644 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8645 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8646
8647 static void
8648 x_check_expected_move (f, expected_left, expected_top)
8649 struct frame *f;
8650 int expected_left;
8651 int expected_top;
8652 {
8653 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8654
8655 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8656 window manager window around the frame. */
8657
8658 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8659
8660 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8661 {
8662 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8663
8664 int adjusted_left;
8665 int adjusted_top;
8666
8667 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8668 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8669 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8670
8671 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8672
8673 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8674 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8675
8676 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8677 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8678
8679 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8680 }
8681 else
8682 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8683 frame's position. */
8684
8685 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8686 }
8687
8688
8689 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8690 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8691 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8692 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8693 of an exact comparison. */
8694
8695 static void
8696 x_sync_with_move (f, left, top, fuzzy)
8697 struct frame *f;
8698 int left, top, fuzzy;
8699 {
8700 int count = 0;
8701
8702 while (count++ < 50)
8703 {
8704 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8705
8706 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8707 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8708 loop. */
8709
8710 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8711 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8712
8713 if (fuzzy)
8714 {
8715 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8716 pixels. */
8717
8718 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
8719 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8720 return;
8721 }
8722 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8723 return;
8724 }
8725
8726 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8727 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8728
8729 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8730 }
8731
8732
8733 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8734 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8735 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8736 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8737
8738 static void
8739 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8740 struct frame *f;
8741 int change_gravity;
8742 int cols, rows;
8743 {
8744 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8745
8746 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8747 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8748 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8749 ? 0
8750 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0
8751 ? FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f)
8752 : (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f)));
8753
8754 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8755
8756 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols);
8757 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows);
8758
8759 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8760 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8761
8762 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8763 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8764 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8765
8766 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8767 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8768 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8769 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8770
8771 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8772 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8773 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8774 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8775 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8776
8777 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8778 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8779 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8780 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8781 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8782
8783 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8784 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8785 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8786 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8787 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8788
8789 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8790 }
8791
8792
8793 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8794 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8795 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8796 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8797
8798 void
8799 x_set_window_size (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8800 struct frame *f;
8801 int change_gravity;
8802 int cols, rows;
8803 {
8804 BLOCK_INPUT;
8805
8806 #ifdef USE_GTK
8807 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8808 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8809 else
8810 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8811 #elif USE_X_TOOLKIT
8812
8813 if (f->output_data.x->widget != NULL)
8814 {
8815 /* The x and y position of the widget is clobbered by the
8816 call to XtSetValues within EmacsFrameSetCharSize.
8817 This is a real kludge, but I don't understand Xt so I can't
8818 figure out a correct fix. Can anyone else tell me? -- rms. */
8819 int xpos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.x;
8820 int ypos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.y;
8821 EmacsFrameSetCharSize (f->output_data.x->edit_widget, cols, rows);
8822 f->output_data.x->widget->core.x = xpos;
8823 f->output_data.x->widget->core.y = ypos;
8824 }
8825 else
8826 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8827
8828 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8829
8830 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8831
8832 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8833
8834 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8835 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8836
8837 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8838 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8839 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8840 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8841 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8842
8843 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8844 }
8845 \f
8846 /* Mouse warping. */
8847
8848 void
8849 x_set_mouse_position (f, x, y)
8850 struct frame *f;
8851 int x, y;
8852 {
8853 int pix_x, pix_y;
8854
8855 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8856 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8857
8858 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8859 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8860
8861 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8862 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8863
8864 BLOCK_INPUT;
8865
8866 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8867 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8868 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8869 }
8870
8871 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8872
8873 void
8874 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (f, pix_x, pix_y)
8875 struct frame *f;
8876 int pix_x, pix_y;
8877 {
8878 BLOCK_INPUT;
8879
8880 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8881 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8882 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8883 }
8884 \f
8885 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
8886
8887 void
8888 x_focus_on_frame (f)
8889 struct frame *f;
8890 {
8891 #if 0
8892 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
8893 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
8894 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
8895 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8896 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8897 #endif /* ! 0 */
8898 }
8899
8900 void
8901 x_unfocus_frame (f)
8902 struct frame *f;
8903 {
8904 #if 0
8905 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
8906 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame == f)
8907 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), PointerRoot,
8908 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8909 #endif /* ! 0 */
8910 }
8911
8912 /* Raise frame F. */
8913
8914 void
8915 x_raise_frame (f)
8916 struct frame *f;
8917 {
8918 BLOCK_INPUT;
8919 if (f->async_visible)
8920 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8921
8922 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8923 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8924 }
8925
8926 /* Lower frame F. */
8927
8928 void
8929 x_lower_frame (f)
8930 struct frame *f;
8931 {
8932 if (f->async_visible)
8933 {
8934 BLOCK_INPUT;
8935 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8936 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8937 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8938 }
8939 }
8940
8941 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
8942
8943 void
8944 x_ewmh_activate_frame (f)
8945 FRAME_PTR f;
8946 {
8947 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8948 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
8949
8950 const char *atom = "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW";
8951 if (f->async_visible && wm_supports (f, atom))
8952 {
8953 Lisp_Object frame;
8954 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8955 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8956 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8957 make_number (32),
8958 Fcons (make_number (1),
8959 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time),
8960 Qnil)));
8961 }
8962 }
8963
8964 static void
8965 XTframe_raise_lower (f, raise_flag)
8966 FRAME_PTR f;
8967 int raise_flag;
8968 {
8969 if (raise_flag)
8970 x_raise_frame (f);
8971 else
8972 x_lower_frame (f);
8973 }
8974 \f
8975 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8976
8977 void
8978 xembed_set_info (f, flags)
8979 struct frame *f;
8980 enum xembed_info flags;
8981 {
8982 Atom atom;
8983 unsigned long data[2];
8984
8985 atom = XInternAtom (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), "_XEMBED_INFO", False);
8986
8987 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
8988 data[1] = flags;
8989
8990 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), atom, atom,
8991 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
8992 }
8993
8994 void
8995 xembed_send_message (f, time, message, detail, data1, data2)
8996 struct frame *f;
8997 Time time;
8998 enum xembed_message message;
8999 long detail;
9000 long data1;
9001 long data2;
9002 {
9003 XEvent event;
9004
9005 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9006 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
9007 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
9008 event.xclient.format = 32;
9009 event.xclient.data.l[0] = time;
9010 event.xclient.data.l[1] = message;
9011 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
9012 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
9013 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
9014
9015 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
9016 False, NoEventMask, &event);
9017 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9018 }
9019 \f
9020 /* Change of visibility. */
9021
9022 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
9023 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
9024 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
9025 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
9026 but it will become visible later when the window manager
9027 finishes with it. */
9028
9029 void
9030 x_make_frame_visible (f)
9031 struct frame *f;
9032 {
9033 Lisp_Object type;
9034 int original_top, original_left;
9035 int retry_count = 2;
9036
9037 retry:
9038
9039 BLOCK_INPUT;
9040
9041 type = x_icon_type (f);
9042 if (!NILP (type))
9043 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9044
9045 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9046 {
9047 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9048 call x_set_offset a second time
9049 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9050 before the window gets really visible. */
9051 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9052 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9053 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
9054 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9055
9056 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
9057
9058 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9059 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
9060 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9061 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9062 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9063 else
9064 {
9065 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9066 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9067 }
9068 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9069 #ifdef USE_GTK
9070 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9071 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9072 #else
9073 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9074 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9075 else
9076 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9077 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9078 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9079 }
9080
9081 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9082
9083 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9084 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9085 so that incoming events are handled. */
9086 {
9087 Lisp_Object frame;
9088 int count;
9089 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9090 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9091 will set it when they are handled. */
9092 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
9093
9094 original_left = f->left_pos;
9095 original_top = f->top_pos;
9096
9097 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9098 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9099
9100 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9101
9102 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9103 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9104 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9105 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9106
9107 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9108 because the window manager may choose the position
9109 and we don't want to override it. */
9110
9111 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9112 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9113 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9114 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
9115 && previously_visible)
9116 {
9117 Drawable rootw;
9118 int x, y;
9119 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
9120
9121 BLOCK_INPUT;
9122
9123 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9124 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9125 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9126 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9127 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9128 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9129 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9130 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9131 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9132
9133 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9134 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9135 original_left, original_top);
9136
9137 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9138 }
9139
9140 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9141
9142 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9143 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9144 MapNotify at all.. */
9145 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9146 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9147 {
9148 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9149 x_sync (f);
9150
9151 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9152 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9153 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9154 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9155 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9156 probably a bug. */
9157 if (input_polling_used ())
9158 {
9159 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9160 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9161 handler reset it. */
9162 extern void poll_for_input_1 P_ ((void));
9163 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9164 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9165 poll_for_input_1 ();
9166 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9167 }
9168
9169 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9170 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9171 }
9172
9173 /* 2000-09-28: In
9174
9175 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9176 (iconify-frame f)
9177 (raise-frame f))
9178
9179 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9180 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9181 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9182 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9183
9184 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
9185 goto retry;
9186 }
9187 }
9188
9189 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9190
9191 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9192
9193 void
9194 x_make_frame_invisible (f)
9195 struct frame *f;
9196 {
9197 Window window;
9198
9199 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9200 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9201
9202 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9203 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9204 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9205
9206 BLOCK_INPUT;
9207
9208 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9209 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9210 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9211 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9212 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9213 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9214
9215 #ifdef USE_GTK
9216 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9217 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9218 else
9219 #else
9220 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9221 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9222 else
9223 #endif
9224 {
9225
9226 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9227 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9228 {
9229 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9230 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9231 }
9232 }
9233
9234 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9235 just by the event that we get from the server.
9236 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9237 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9238 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9239 f->visible = 0;
9240 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9241 f->async_visible = 0;
9242 f->async_iconified = 0;
9243
9244 x_sync (f);
9245
9246 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9247 }
9248
9249 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9250
9251 void
9252 x_iconify_frame (f)
9253 struct frame *f;
9254 {
9255 int result;
9256 Lisp_Object type;
9257
9258 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9259 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9260 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9261
9262 if (f->async_iconified)
9263 return;
9264
9265 BLOCK_INPUT;
9266
9267 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9268
9269 type = x_icon_type (f);
9270 if (!NILP (type))
9271 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9272
9273 #ifdef USE_GTK
9274 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9275 {
9276 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9277 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9278
9279 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9280 f->iconified = 1;
9281 f->visible = 1;
9282 f->async_iconified = 1;
9283 f->async_visible = 0;
9284 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9285 return;
9286 }
9287 #endif
9288
9289 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9290
9291 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9292 {
9293 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9294 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9295 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9296 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9297 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9298 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9299 so we have to record it here. */
9300 f->iconified = 1;
9301 f->visible = 1;
9302 f->async_iconified = 1;
9303 f->async_visible = 0;
9304 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9305 return;
9306 }
9307
9308 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9309 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9310 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9311 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9312
9313 if (!result)
9314 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9315
9316 f->async_iconified = 1;
9317 f->async_visible = 0;
9318
9319
9320 BLOCK_INPUT;
9321 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9322 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9323 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9324
9325 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9326 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9327 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9328 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9329 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9330 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9331
9332 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9333 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9334
9335 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9336 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9337 {
9338 XEvent message;
9339
9340 message.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9341 message.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9342 message.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9343 message.xclient.format = 32;
9344 message.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9345
9346 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9347 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9348 False,
9349 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9350 &message))
9351 {
9352 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9353 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9354 }
9355 }
9356
9357 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9358 IconicState. */
9359 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9360
9361 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9362 {
9363 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9364 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9365 }
9366
9367 f->async_iconified = 1;
9368 f->async_visible = 0;
9369
9370 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9371 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9372 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9373 }
9374
9375 \f
9376 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9377
9378 void
9379 x_free_frame_resources (f)
9380 struct frame *f;
9381 {
9382 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9383 Lisp_Object bar;
9384 struct scroll_bar *b;
9385
9386 BLOCK_INPUT;
9387
9388 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9389 commands to the X server. */
9390 if (dpyinfo->display)
9391 {
9392 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9393 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9394 face. */
9395 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9396 free_frame_faces (f);
9397
9398 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9399 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9400
9401 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9402 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9403 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9404 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9405 toolkit scroll bars. */
9406 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9407 {
9408 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9409 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9410 }
9411 #endif
9412
9413 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9414 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9415 free_frame_xic (f);
9416 #endif
9417
9418 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9419 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9420 {
9421 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9422 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9423 }
9424 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9425 we are using a toolkit. */
9426 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9427 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9428
9429 free_frame_menubar (f);
9430 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9431
9432 #ifdef USE_GTK
9433 /* In the GTK version, tooltips are normal X
9434 frames. We must check and free both types. */
9435 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9436 {
9437 gtk_widget_destroy (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9438 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) = 0; /* Set to avoid XDestroyWindow below */
9439 FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f) = 0;
9440 }
9441 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9442
9443 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9444 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9445 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9446
9447 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9448 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9449 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9450 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9451 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9452 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9453
9454 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9455 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9456 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9457 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9458 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9459 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9460 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9461 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9462 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9463 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9464 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9465 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9466 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9467 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9468 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9469
9470 x_free_gcs (f);
9471 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9472 }
9473
9474 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9475 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9476 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9477
9478 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9479 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9480 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9481 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9482 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9483 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9484
9485 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9486 {
9487 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9488 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9489 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9490 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9491 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9492 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9493 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9494 }
9495
9496 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9497 }
9498
9499
9500 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9501
9502 void
9503 x_destroy_window (f)
9504 struct frame *f;
9505 {
9506 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9507
9508 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9509 commands to the X server. */
9510 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9511 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9512
9513 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9514 }
9515
9516 \f
9517 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9518
9519 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9520 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9521 that the window now has.
9522 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9523 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9524 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9525
9526 #ifndef USE_GTK
9527 void
9528 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, flags, user_position)
9529 struct frame *f;
9530 long flags;
9531 int user_position;
9532 {
9533 XSizeHints size_hints;
9534
9535 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9536 Arg al[2];
9537 int ac = 0;
9538 Dimension widget_width, widget_height;
9539 #endif
9540
9541 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9542
9543 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9544 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9545
9546 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9547 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9548
9549 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9550 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNwidth, &widget_width); ac++;
9551 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNheight, &widget_height); ac++;
9552 XtGetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, ac);
9553 size_hints.height = widget_height;
9554 size_hints.width = widget_width;
9555 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9556 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9557 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9558 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9559
9560 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9561 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9562 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9563 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9564 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9565 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9566
9567 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes.
9568
9569 (When we use the X toolkit, we don't do it here.
9570 Instead we copy the values that the widgets are using, below.) */
9571 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9572 {
9573 int base_width, base_height;
9574 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9575
9576 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9577 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9578
9579 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9580
9581 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9582 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9583 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9584 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9585 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9586
9587 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9588 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9589 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9590
9591 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9592 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9593 size_hints.base_height = base_height;
9594 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9595 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9596 }
9597
9598 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9599 if (flags)
9600 {
9601 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9602 goto no_read;
9603 }
9604 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9605
9606 {
9607 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9608 long supplied_return;
9609 int value;
9610
9611 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9612 &supplied_return);
9613
9614 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9615 size_hints.base_height = hints.base_height;
9616 size_hints.base_width = hints.base_width;
9617 size_hints.min_height = hints.min_height;
9618 size_hints.min_width = hints.min_width;
9619 #endif
9620
9621 if (flags)
9622 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9623 else
9624 {
9625 if (value == 0)
9626 hints.flags = 0;
9627 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9628 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9629 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9630 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9631 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9632 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9633 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9634 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9635 }
9636 }
9637
9638 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9639 no_read:
9640 #endif
9641
9642 #ifdef PWinGravity
9643 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9644 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9645
9646 if (user_position)
9647 {
9648 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9649 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9650 }
9651 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9652
9653 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9654 }
9655 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9656
9657 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9658
9659 void
9660 x_wm_set_window_state (f, state)
9661 struct frame *f;
9662 int state;
9663 {
9664 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9665 Arg al[1];
9666
9667 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9668 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9669 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9670 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9671
9672 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9673 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9674
9675 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9676 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9677 }
9678
9679 void
9680 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, pixmap_id)
9681 struct frame *f;
9682 int pixmap_id;
9683 {
9684 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9685
9686 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9687 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9688 #endif
9689
9690 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9691 {
9692 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9693 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9694 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9695 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9696 }
9697 else
9698 {
9699 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9700 pixmap. */
9701 return;
9702 }
9703
9704
9705 #ifdef USE_GTK
9706 {
9707 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9708 return;
9709 }
9710
9711 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9712
9713 {
9714 Arg al[1];
9715 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9716 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9717 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9718 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9719 }
9720
9721 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9722
9723 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9724 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9725
9726 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9727 }
9728
9729 void
9730 x_wm_set_icon_position (f, icon_x, icon_y)
9731 struct frame *f;
9732 int icon_x, icon_y;
9733 {
9734 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9735
9736 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9737 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9738 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9739
9740 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9741 }
9742
9743 \f
9744 /***********************************************************************
9745 Fonts
9746 ***********************************************************************/
9747
9748 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9749
9750 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9751 font table. */
9752
9753 static void
9754 x_check_font (f, font)
9755 struct frame *f;
9756 struct font *font;
9757 {
9758 Lisp_Object frame;
9759
9760 xassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
9761 if (font->driver->check)
9762 xassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
9763 }
9764
9765 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9766
9767 \f
9768 /***********************************************************************
9769 Initialization
9770 ***********************************************************************/
9771
9772 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9773 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9774 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9775 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9776
9777 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9778 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9779 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9780
9781 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9782 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9783 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9784 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9785 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9786 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9787 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9788 };
9789
9790 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9791
9792 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
9793
9794 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9795
9796 static int x_initialized;
9797
9798 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
9799 static int x_session_initialized;
9800 #endif
9801
9802 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9803 the screen number from the server number. */
9804 static int
9805 same_x_server (name1, name2)
9806 const char *name1, *name2;
9807 {
9808 int seen_colon = 0;
9809 const unsigned char *system_name = SDATA (Vsystem_name);
9810 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
9811 int length_until_period = 0;
9812
9813 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
9814 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
9815 length_until_period++;
9816
9817 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9818 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
9819 name1 += 4;
9820 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
9821 name2 += 4;
9822 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9823 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
9824 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
9825 name1 += system_name_length;
9826 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
9827 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
9828 name2 += system_name_length;
9829 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9830 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
9831 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
9832 name1 += length_until_period;
9833 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
9834 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
9835 name2 += length_until_period;
9836
9837 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
9838 {
9839 if (*name1 == ':')
9840 seen_colon++;
9841 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
9842 return 1;
9843 }
9844 return (seen_colon
9845 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
9846 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
9847 }
9848
9849 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9850 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9851 to 5. */
9852 static void
9853 get_bits_and_offset (mask, bits, offset)
9854 unsigned long mask;
9855 int *bits;
9856 int *offset;
9857 {
9858 int nr = 0;
9859 int off = 0;
9860
9861 while (!(mask & 1))
9862 {
9863 off++;
9864 mask >>= 1;
9865 }
9866
9867 while (mask & 1)
9868 {
9869 nr++;
9870 mask >>= 1;
9871 }
9872
9873 *offset = off;
9874 *bits = nr;
9875 }
9876
9877 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9878 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9879
9880 int
9881 x_display_ok (display)
9882 const char *display;
9883 {
9884 int dpy_ok = 1;
9885 Display *dpy;
9886
9887 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
9888 if (dpy)
9889 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
9890 else
9891 dpy_ok = 0;
9892 return dpy_ok;
9893 }
9894
9895 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
9896 the structure that describes the open display.
9897 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
9898
9899 struct x_display_info *
9900 x_term_init (display_name, xrm_option, resource_name)
9901 Lisp_Object display_name;
9902 char *xrm_option;
9903 char *resource_name;
9904 {
9905 int connection;
9906 Display *dpy;
9907 struct terminal *terminal;
9908 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9909 XrmDatabase xrdb;
9910
9911 BLOCK_INPUT;
9912
9913 if (!x_initialized)
9914 {
9915 x_initialize ();
9916 ++x_initialized;
9917 }
9918
9919 if (! x_display_ok (SDATA (display_name)))
9920 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SDATA (display_name));
9921
9922 #ifdef USE_GTK
9923 {
9924 #define NUM_ARGV 10
9925 int argc;
9926 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
9927 char **argv2 = argv;
9928 GdkAtom atom;
9929
9930 #ifndef HAVE_GTK_MULTIDISPLAY
9931 if (!EQ (Vinitial_window_system, intern ("x")))
9932 error ("Sorry, you cannot connect to X servers with the GTK toolkit");
9933 #endif
9934
9935 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
9936 {
9937 #ifdef HAVE_GTK_MULTIDISPLAY
9938 /* Opening another display. If xg_display_open returns less
9939 than zero, we are probably on GTK 2.0, which can only handle
9940 one display. GTK 2.2 or later can handle more than one. */
9941 if (xg_display_open (SDATA (display_name), &dpy) < 0)
9942 #endif
9943 error ("Sorry, this version of GTK can only handle one display");
9944 }
9945 else
9946 {
9947 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
9948 argv[argc] = 0;
9949
9950 argc = 0;
9951 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
9952
9953 if (! NILP (display_name))
9954 {
9955 argv[argc++] = "--display";
9956 argv[argc++] = SDATA (display_name);
9957 }
9958
9959 argv[argc++] = "--name";
9960 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
9961
9962 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9963
9964 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
9965
9966 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
9967 fixup_locale ();
9968 xg_initialize ();
9969
9970 dpy = GDK_DISPLAY ();
9971
9972 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
9973 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
9974
9975 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
9976 {
9977 char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
9978 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
9979
9980 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
9981 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
9982
9983 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
9984 gtk_rc_parse (SDATA (abs_file));
9985 }
9986
9987 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
9988 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
9989 }
9990 }
9991 #else /* not USE_GTK */
9992 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9993 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
9994 errors with X11R5:
9995 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
9996 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
9997 So let's not use it until R6. */
9998 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9999 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
10000 #endif
10001
10002 {
10003 int argc = 0;
10004 char *argv[3];
10005
10006 argv[0] = "";
10007 argc = 1;
10008 if (xrm_option)
10009 {
10010 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
10011 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
10012 }
10013 turn_on_atimers (0);
10014 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SDATA (display_name),
10015 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
10016 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
10017 &argc, argv);
10018 turn_on_atimers (1);
10019
10020 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10021 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10022 fixup_locale ();
10023 #endif
10024 }
10025
10026 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10027 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10028 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SDATA (display_name));
10029 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10030 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10031
10032 /* Detect failure. */
10033 if (dpy == 0)
10034 {
10035 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10036 return 0;
10037 }
10038
10039 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10040
10041 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
10042 bzero (dpyinfo, sizeof *dpyinfo);
10043
10044 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
10045
10046 {
10047 struct x_display_info *share;
10048 Lisp_Object tail;
10049
10050 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10051 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10052 if (same_x_server (SDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10053 SDATA (display_name)))
10054 break;
10055 if (share)
10056 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
10057 else
10058 {
10059 terminal->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
10060 init_kboard (terminal->kboard);
10061 terminal->kboard->Vwindow_system = intern ("x");
10062 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10063 {
10064 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10065 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal */
10066 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
10067 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10068 terminal->kboard->Vsystem_key_alist
10069 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10070 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string);
10071 BLOCK_INPUT;
10072 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
10073 terminal_list = terminal;
10074 }
10075
10076 terminal->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10077 all_kboards = terminal->kboard;
10078 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10079 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10080 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10081 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10082 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
10083 }
10084 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
10085 }
10086
10087 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10088 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10089 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10090
10091 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10092 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10093 x_display_name_list);
10094 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10095
10096 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10097
10098 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10099 terminal->name = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name) + 1);
10100 strncpy (terminal->name, SDATA (display_name), SBYTES (display_name));
10101 terminal->name[SBYTES (display_name)] = 0;
10102
10103 #if 0
10104 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10105 #endif /* ! 0 */
10106
10107 dpyinfo->x_id_name
10108 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10109 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
10110 + 2);
10111 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
10112 SDATA (Vinvocation_name), SDATA (Vsystem_name));
10113
10114 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10115 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10116
10117 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10118 #ifdef USE_GTK
10119 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10120 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10121 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10122
10123 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10124 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10125
10126 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10127 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10128 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10129 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10130 #else
10131 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10132 #endif
10133 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10134 all versions. */
10135 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10136
10137 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10138 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10139 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10140 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10141 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10142 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10143 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10144 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10145 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10146 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10147 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10148 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10149 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10150 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10151 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10152 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10153 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10154 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10155 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10156 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10157 dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10158 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10159 dpyinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10160 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10161 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10162 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10163 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10164 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10165
10166 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10167 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10168 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10169
10170 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10171 {
10172 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10173 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10174 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10175 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10176 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10177 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10178 }
10179
10180 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10181 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10182 {
10183 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10184 {
10185 Lisp_Object value;
10186 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10187 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10188 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10189 Qnil, Qnil);
10190 if (STRINGP (value)
10191 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10192 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10193 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10194 }
10195 }
10196 else
10197 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10198 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10199
10200 {
10201 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10202 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10203 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10204 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10205 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10206 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10207 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10208 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10209 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10210 }
10211
10212 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
10213 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_PROTOCOLS", False);
10214 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus
10215 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", False);
10216 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
10217 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", False);
10218 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window
10219 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", False);
10220 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state
10221 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CHANGE_STATE", False);
10222 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
10223 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", False);
10224 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved
10225 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_MOVED", False);
10226 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader
10227 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", False);
10228 dpyinfo->Xatom_editres
10229 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "Editres", False);
10230 dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD
10231 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "CLIPBOARD", False);
10232 dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP
10233 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TIMESTAMP", False);
10234 dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT
10235 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TEXT", False);
10236 dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
10237 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "COMPOUND_TEXT", False);
10238 dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING
10239 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "UTF8_STRING", False);
10240 dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE
10241 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DELETE", False);
10242 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE
10243 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "MULTIPLE", False);
10244 dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR
10245 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "INCR", False);
10246 dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP
10247 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_EMACS_TMP_", False);
10248 dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS
10249 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TARGETS", False);
10250 dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL
10251 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "NULL", False);
10252 dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
10253 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "ATOM_PAIR", False);
10254 /* For properties of font. */
10255 dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
10256 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PIXEL_SIZE", False);
10257 dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH
10258 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "AVERAGE_WIDTH", False);
10259 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
10260 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", False);
10261 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
10262 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", False);
10263 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
10264 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", False);
10265
10266 /* Ghostscript support. */
10267 dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PAGE", False);
10268 dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DONE", False);
10269
10270 dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "SCROLLBAR",
10271 False);
10272
10273 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_XEMBED",
10274 False);
10275
10276 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state
10277 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_STATE", False);
10278 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen_atom
10279 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", False);
10280 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
10281 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ", False);
10282 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
10283 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT", False);
10284
10285 dpyinfo->cut_buffers_initialized = 0;
10286
10287 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10288 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10289 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof (*dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms)
10290 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10291
10292 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10293 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10294 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10295
10296 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10297 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10298
10299 {
10300 extern int gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height;
10301 extern char *gray_bitmap_bits;
10302 dpyinfo->gray
10303 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10304 gray_bitmap_bits,
10305 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
10306 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
10307 }
10308
10309 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10310 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10311 #endif
10312
10313 #ifdef subprocesses
10314 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10315 if (connection != 0)
10316 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10317 #endif
10318
10319 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10320 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10321 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10322
10323 #ifdef SIGIO
10324 if (interrupt_input)
10325 init_sigio (connection);
10326 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10327
10328 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10329 {
10330 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10331 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10332 Font font;
10333
10334 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10335 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10336 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10337 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10338 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10339 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10340 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10341 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10342 abort ();
10343 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10344 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10345 x_uncatch_errors ();
10346 }
10347 #endif
10348
10349 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10350 for debugging X code. */
10351 {
10352 Lisp_Object value;
10353 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10354 build_string ("synchronous"),
10355 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10356 Qnil, Qnil);
10357 if (STRINGP (value)
10358 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10359 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10360 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10361 }
10362
10363 {
10364 Lisp_Object value;
10365 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10366 build_string ("useXIM"),
10367 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10368 Qnil, Qnil);
10369 #ifdef USE_XIM
10370 if (STRINGP (value)
10371 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "false")
10372 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "off")))
10373 use_xim = 0;
10374 #else
10375 if (STRINGP (value)
10376 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10377 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10378 use_xim = 1;
10379 #endif
10380 }
10381
10382 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10383 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10384 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10385 tty. */
10386 if (terminal->id == 1)
10387 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10388 #endif
10389
10390 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10391
10392 return dpyinfo;
10393 }
10394 \f
10395 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10396 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10397
10398 void
10399 x_delete_display (dpyinfo)
10400 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10401 {
10402 int i;
10403 struct terminal *t;
10404
10405 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10406 X display. */
10407 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
10408 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
10409 {
10410 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10411 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10412 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10413 x_session_close();
10414 #endif
10415 delete_terminal (t);
10416 break;
10417 }
10418
10419 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10420
10421 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10422 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10423 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10424 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10425 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10426 else
10427 {
10428 Lisp_Object tail;
10429
10430 tail = x_display_name_list;
10431 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10432 {
10433 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10434 {
10435 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10436 break;
10437 }
10438 tail = XCDR (tail);
10439 }
10440 }
10441
10442 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10443 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10444
10445 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10446 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10447 else
10448 {
10449 struct x_display_info *tail;
10450
10451 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10452 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10453 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10454 }
10455
10456 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10457 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
10458 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10459 xfree (dpyinfo);
10460 }
10461
10462 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10463
10464 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10465 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10466 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10467 that slows us down. */
10468
10469 static void
10470 x_process_timeouts (timer)
10471 struct atimer *timer;
10472 {
10473 BLOCK_INPUT;
10474 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
10475 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10476 {
10477 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10478 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10479 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10480 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10481 }
10482 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10483 }
10484
10485 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10486 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10487 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10488 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10489 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10490 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10491 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10492
10493 void
10494 x_activate_timeout_atimer ()
10495 {
10496 BLOCK_INPUT;
10497 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
10498 {
10499 EMACS_TIME interval;
10500
10501 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
10502 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10503 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
10504 }
10505 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10506 }
10507
10508 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10509
10510 \f
10511 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10512
10513 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10514
10515 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10516 {
10517 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10518 x_produce_glyphs,
10519 x_write_glyphs,
10520 x_insert_glyphs,
10521 x_clear_end_of_line,
10522 x_scroll_run,
10523 x_after_update_window_line,
10524 x_update_window_begin,
10525 x_update_window_end,
10526 x_cursor_to,
10527 x_flush,
10528 #ifdef XFlush
10529 x_flush,
10530 #else
10531 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10532 #endif
10533 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10534 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10535 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10536 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10537 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10538 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10539 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10540 x_draw_glyph_string,
10541 x_define_frame_cursor,
10542 x_clear_frame_area,
10543 x_draw_window_cursor,
10544 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10545 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10546 };
10547
10548
10549 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10550 void
10551 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
10552 {
10553 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
10554 int i;
10555
10556 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10557 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10558 if (!terminal->name)
10559 return;
10560
10561 BLOCK_INPUT;
10562 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10563 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10564 X display. */
10565 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10566 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10567 #endif
10568
10569 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10570 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10571 if (dpyinfo->display)
10572 {
10573 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
10574 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
10575
10576 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10577 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10578 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10579 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10580
10581 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10582 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10583 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10584 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10585 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10586 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10587 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10588 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10589 leaks in other situations. */
10590 #if 0
10591 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10592 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
10593 #else
10594 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
10595 #endif
10596 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10597 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10598 closing all the displays. */
10599 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10600 #endif
10601
10602 #ifdef USE_GTK
10603 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
10604 #else
10605 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10606 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10607 #else
10608 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10609 #endif
10610 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10611 }
10612
10613 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
10614 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10615 }
10616
10617 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10618 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10619
10620 static struct terminal *
10621 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10622 {
10623 struct terminal *terminal;
10624
10625 terminal = create_terminal ();
10626
10627 terminal->type = output_x_window;
10628 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
10629 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
10630
10631 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10632
10633 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10634 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10635 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10636 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10637 terminal->reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10638 terminal->set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10639 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10640 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10641 terminal->set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10642 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10643 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10644 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10645 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10646 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10647 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
10648 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10649 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10650 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10651 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10652
10653 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
10654 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
10655
10656 terminal->rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10657 terminal->scroll_region_ok = 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10658 terminal->char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10659 terminal->line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10660 terminal->fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well. */
10661 terminal->memory_below_frame = 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10662 off the bottom. */
10663
10664 return terminal;
10665 }
10666
10667 void
10668 x_initialize ()
10669 {
10670 baud_rate = 19200;
10671
10672 x_noop_count = 0;
10673 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10674 any_help_event_p = 0;
10675 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10676 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10677 x_session_initialized = 0;
10678 #endif
10679
10680 #ifdef USE_GTK
10681 current_count = -1;
10682 #endif
10683
10684 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10685 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
10686
10687 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10688 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10689
10690 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10691
10692 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10693 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10694 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10695 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10696 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10697 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10698 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10699
10700 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10701 #endif
10702
10703 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10704 #ifndef USE_GTK
10705 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10706 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10707 #endif
10708 #endif
10709
10710 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10711 original error handler. */
10712 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10713 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10714
10715 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10716 }
10717
10718
10719 void
10720 syms_of_xterm ()
10721 {
10722 x_error_message = NULL;
10723
10724 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10725 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10726
10727 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10728 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10729
10730 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
10731 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
10732
10733 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
10734 Qlatin_1 = intern ("latin-1");
10735
10736 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10737 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10738
10739 #ifdef USE_GTK
10740 xg_default_icon_file = build_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10741 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
10742 #endif
10743
10744 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10745 &x_use_underline_position_properties,
10746 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10747 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10748 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10749 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10750 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10751 sizes. */);
10752 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10753
10754 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10755 &x_underline_at_descent_line,
10756 doc: /* *Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10757 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10758 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10759 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10760 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
10761
10762 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10763 &x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10764 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10765 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10766 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10767 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10768 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10769 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10770 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10771
10772 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", &Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10773 doc: /* What X toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses.
10774 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use X toolkit scroll bars.
10775 Otherwise, value is a symbol describing the X toolkit. */);
10776 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10777 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10778 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("motif");
10779 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10780 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw3d");
10781 #elif USE_GTK
10782 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("gtk");
10783 #else
10784 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw");
10785 #endif
10786 #else
10787 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10788 #endif
10789
10790 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10791 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10792
10793 Qmodifier_value = intern ("modifier-value");
10794 Qalt = intern ("alt");
10795 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10796 Qhyper = intern ("hyper");
10797 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10798 Qmeta = intern ("meta");
10799 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10800 Qsuper = intern ("super");
10801 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10802
10803 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", &Vx_alt_keysym,
10804 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10805 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10806 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10807 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10808 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10809
10810 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", &Vx_hyper_keysym,
10811 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10812 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10813 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10814 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10815 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10816
10817 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", &Vx_meta_keysym,
10818 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10819 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10820 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10821 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10822 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10823
10824 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", &Vx_super_keysym,
10825 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10826 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10827 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10828 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10829 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10830
10831 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", &Vx_keysym_table,
10832 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10833 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10834 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10835 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10836 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10837 }
10838
10839 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */
10840
10841 /* arch-tag: 6d4e4cb7-abc1-4302-9585-d84dcfb09d0f
10842 (do not change this comment) */